blob: d5140337564c600879757aac014501ab99ab18ad [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Christopher Fauletec554342022-09-28 14:51:49 +02006 2022/09/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001219.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200122
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012310. FastCGI applications
12410.1. Setup
12510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12610.1.2. Proxy section
12710.1.3. Example
12810.2. Default parameters
12910.3. Limitations
130
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013111. Address formats
13211.1. Address family prefixes
13311.2. Socket type prefixes
13411.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
1361. Quick reminder about HTTP
137----------------------------
138
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100139When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
141on almost anything found in the contents.
142
143However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
144formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
145correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
146
147
1481.1. The HTTP transaction model
149-------------------------------
150
151The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100152to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100153from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
154connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155will involve a new connection :
156
157 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
158
159In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
160establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
161by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
162length.
163
164Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
165to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
166however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
167response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
168header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
169
170 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
171
172Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
173power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
174but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200175a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100177Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
179second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
180page :
181
182 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
183
184This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
185latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
186correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
187the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100188server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
191time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
192are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
193parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
194carry the stream identifier.
195
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100196By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
197connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
198leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100199start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
200processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
201waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200202
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
205 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100206 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100207 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200208 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211
2121.2. HTTP request
213-----------------
214
215First, let's consider this HTTP request :
216
217 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
220 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
221 3 User-agent: my small browser
222 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
223 5 Accept: image/png
224
225
2261.2.1. The Request line
227-----------------------
228
229Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
230
231 - a METHOD : GET
232 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
233 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
234
235All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
236which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
237followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
238is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
239desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
240the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
241
242The URI itself can have several forms :
243
244 - A "relative URI" :
245
246 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
247
248 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
249 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
250
251 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
252
253 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
254
255 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
256 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
257 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
258 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
259 must accept this form too.
260
261 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
262 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
263 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200265 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
266 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
267 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
268 other protocols too.
269
270In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
271mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
272on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
273It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
274specific to the language, framework or application in use.
275
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100277assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200295as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
296normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
297representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
298HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400339over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400383 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200388 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
390 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
391 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
392
393The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3944.2).
395
396
3971.3.2. The response headers
398---------------------------
399
400Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
401the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
402details.
403
404
4052. Configuring HAProxy
406----------------------
407
4082.1. Configuration file format
409------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
411HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
412
413 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700415 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200417
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
419a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100420
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100421 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
422
423 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
424
425 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
426 tab characters
427
428 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
429 keyword sequences listed in this document
430
431 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
432 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
433 parts of the configuration, or expressions
434
435 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
436 are supported
437
438 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
439 section
440
441This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
442generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
443figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
444
445First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
446the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
447a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
448word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
449follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
450the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
451the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
452the parts that need to be addressed.
453
454A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
455requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
456extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
457the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
458section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
459section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
460not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
461
462A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
463each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
464a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
465start a new one.
466
467Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
468that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
469applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
470"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
471processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
472ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
473which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
474In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
475of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
476identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
477such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4782, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
479
480 listen foo
481 bind :80
482
483 listen bar
484 bind :81
485
486Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
487spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
488of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
489following configurations are strictly equivalent:
490
491 global#this is the global section
492 daemon#daemonize
493 frontend foo
494 mode http # or tcp
495
496and:
497
498 global
499 daemon
500
501 # this is the public web frontend
502 frontend foo
503 mode http
504
505The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
506new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
507other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
508section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
509section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
510at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
511
512Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
513are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
514editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
515support automatic indent.
516
517In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
518positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
519modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
520anymore, and is not recommended.
521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200522
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005232.2. Quoting and escaping
524-------------------------
525
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100526In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
527that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
528possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
529in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
530('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200531
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100532This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
533very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
534the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
535also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
536delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
537word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
538remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
541(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
542
543Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
544backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200545
546 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
547 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
548 \\ to use a backslash
549 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
550 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
551
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100552In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
553C-language representation:
554
555 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
556 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
557 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
558 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
559
560Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
561or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
562of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200563
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100564 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
566 # hash as a comment start
567
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100568Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
569evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
570dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
571backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
574character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
575is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200576
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100577As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
578entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
579name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
580represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
581hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200582
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100583 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
584 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
585 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
586 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
587 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
588 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
589 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
590 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
591 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
592 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
593 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200594
595 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200597 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
598 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
599 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
602
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100603There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
604necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
605by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
606they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
607escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
608characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
609case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
610if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
611own quotes.
612
613The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600614quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500615not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100616quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
617
618Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
619arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
620
621 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
622 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
623
624Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
625"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
626cannot write:
627
628 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
629
630because we would like the string to cut like this:
631
632 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
633 |---------|----|-|
634 arg1 _/ / /
635 arg2 __________/ /
636 arg3 ______________/
637
638but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
639parenthesis then garbage:
640
641 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
642 |--------|--------|
643 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
644 trailing garbage _________/
645
646The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
647quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
648processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
649this word:
650
651 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
652 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
653 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
654
655So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
656still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
657the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
658the second level:
659
660 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
661 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
662 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
663 |---------||----|-|
664 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
665 arg2=blah ___________/ /
666 arg3=g _______________/
667
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500668Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100669double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
670
671 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
672 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
673 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
674 |---------||----|-|
675 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
676 arg2 ___________/ /
677 arg3 _______________/
678
679When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
680appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
681string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
682thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
683
684 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
685 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
686 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
687 |-------------| |-----||-|
688 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
689 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
690 arg3 ______________________/
691
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400692Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600693that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
695single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
696level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
697
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600698Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
699if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
700or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
701
702 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
705
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100706When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
707double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600708and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100709a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
710a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
711the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
712regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
713around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
714more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200715
716
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007172.3. Environment variables
718--------------------------
719
720HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
721interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
722configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
723optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
724shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200725underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
726list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
727arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
728before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200729
730 Example:
731
732 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
733
734 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
735
736 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
737
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200738Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
739file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200740
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200741* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
742 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
743
744* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
745 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
746 directory.
747
748* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
749
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500750* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200751 processes, separated by semicolons.
752
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500753* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200754 CLI, separated by semicolons.
755
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200756In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
757regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
758only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
759
760* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
761
762* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
763 starting at one.
764
765* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
766 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
767 first section.
768
769These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
770if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
771section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
772"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
773proxies.
774
775This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
776logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
777to name some config objects like servers for example.
778
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200779See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200780
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100781
7822.4. Conditional blocks
783-----------------------
784
785It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
786some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
787ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
788configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
789versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
790preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
791text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
792lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
793switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
794are defined to form conditional blocks:
795
796 - .if <condition>
797 - .elif <condition>
798 - .else
799 - .endif
800
801The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
802as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
803matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
804there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
805only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
806".elif" of a block.
807
808Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
809ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
810as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
811
812The conditions are currently limited to:
813
814 - an empty string, always returns "false"
815 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
816 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200817 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
818
819The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
820
821 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
822 exists, regardless of its contents
823
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200824 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
825 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
826 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
827
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200828 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
829 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
830
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200831 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
832 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
833 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
834 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
835
836 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
837 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
838 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
839 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
840
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200841Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100842
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200843 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
844 listen mwcli_px
845 bind :1111
846 ...
847 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100848
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200849 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
850 bind :80
851 .endif
852
853 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200854 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200855 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200856 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200857 .endif
858
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200859 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
860 profiling.memory on
861 .endif
862
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200863Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100864
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200865 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100866 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
867 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
868 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
869
870Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
871"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
872fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
873provide advice to the user.
874
875Example:
876
877 .if "${A}"
878 .if "${B}"
879 .notice "A=1, B=1"
880 .elif "${C}"
881 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
882 .elif "${D}"
883 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
884 .else
885 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
886 .endif
887 .else
888 .notice "A=0"
889 .endif
890
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200891 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
892 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
893
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100894
8952.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200896----------------
897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100898Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100899values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
900otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
901numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
902for every keyword. Supported units are :
903
904 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
905 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
906 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
907 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
908 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
909 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
910
911
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009122.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200913-------------
914
915 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
916 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
917 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
918 global
919 daemon
920 maxconn 256
921
922 defaults
923 mode http
924 timeout connect 5000ms
925 timeout client 50000ms
926 timeout server 50000ms
927
928 frontend http-in
929 bind *:80
930 default_backend servers
931
932 backend servers
933 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
934
935
936 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
937 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
938 global
939 daemon
940 maxconn 256
941
942 defaults
943 mode http
944 timeout connect 5000ms
945 timeout client 50000ms
946 timeout server 50000ms
947
948 listen http-in
949 bind *:80
950 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
951
952
953Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
954
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100955 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200956
957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009583. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200959--------------------
960
961Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
962are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
963of them have command-line equivalents.
964
965The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
966
967 * Process management and security
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100968 - 51degrees-cache-size
969 - 51degrees-data-file
970 - 51degrees-property-name-list
971 - 51degrees-property-separator
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200972 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200973 - chroot
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200974 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100975 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200976 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200977 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200978 - description
979 - deviceatlas-json-file
980 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200981 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100982 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200983 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900984 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200985 - gid
986 - group
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200987 - h1-case-adjust
988 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100989 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
990 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100991 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100992 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100993 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200994 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100996 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100997 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200998 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100999 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001000 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001001 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001002 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001003 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001004 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001005 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001007 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001008 - presetenv
1009 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001010 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001011 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001012 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001013 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001014 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001015 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001016 - ssl-default-bind-options
1017 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001018 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - ssl-default-server-options
1020 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001021 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001022 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001023 - stats
1024 - strict-limits
1025 - uid
1026 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001027 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001028 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001029 - user
1030 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001031 - wurfl-data-file
1032 - wurfl-information-list
1033 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001034
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001036 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001037 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001038 - maxcompcpuusage
1039 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001040 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001041 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001042 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001043 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001044 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001045 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001046 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001047 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001049 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001050 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001051 - nokqueue
1052 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001053 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001054 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001055 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001056 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001057 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001058 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001059 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001060 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001061 - tune.buffers.limit
1062 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001063 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001064 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001065 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001066 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001067 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001068 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001069 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001070 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001071 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001072 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001073 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001074 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001075 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001076 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001077 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001078 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1079 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001080 - tune.maxaccept
1081 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001082 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001083 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001084 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001085 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1086 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001087 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1088 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001089 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001090 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001091 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001092 - tune.sndbuf.client
1093 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001094 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001095 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
1096 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
1097 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001098 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001099 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1100 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001101 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001102 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001103 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001104 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1105 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1106 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001107 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1108 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001111 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001112 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
1114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116------------------------------------
1117
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100111851degrees-data-file <file path>
1119 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1120 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1121
1122 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1123 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1124
112551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1126 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1127 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1128 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1129
1130 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1131 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1132
113351degrees-property-separator <char>
1134 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1135 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1136
1137 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1138 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1139
114051degrees-cache-size <number>
1141 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1142 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1143 By default, this cache is disabled.
1144
1145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1146 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1147
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001148ca-base <dir>
1149 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001150 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1151 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1152 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001153
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001154chroot <jail dir>
1155 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1156 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1157 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1158 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1159 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001160 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001161
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001162cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1163 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1164 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1165 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1166 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1167 set. These sets have the format
1168
1169 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1170
1171 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001172 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001173 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1174 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001175 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1176 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001177 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1178 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1179 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1180 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1181 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1182 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1183 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1184 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1185 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1186 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001187
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001188 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1189 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1190 on the machine's word size.
1191
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001192 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001193 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1194 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1195 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1196 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1197 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1198 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001199
1200 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001201 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1202
1203 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1204 # first 4 CPUs
1205
1206 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1207 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1208 # word size.
1209
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001210 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001211 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001212 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1213 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1214 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1215
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001216 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1217 # and so on.
1218 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1219 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1220 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1221
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001222 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001223 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1224 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1225 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1226
1227 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1228 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1229 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1230
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001231 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1232 # and a thread range.
1233 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1234 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1235 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1236
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001237crt-base <dir>
1238 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001239 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1240 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001241
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001242daemon
1243 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1244 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001245 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1246 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001247
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001248default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001249 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001250 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1251 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1252 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1253 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1254 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1255 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1256 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1257 not start with a slash ('/'):
1258 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1259 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1260
1261 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1262 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1263 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1264 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1265 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1266 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1267 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1268 each of them.
1269
1270 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1271 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1272 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1273 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1274 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1275 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1276 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1277 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1278
1279 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1280 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001281 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001282 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1283 made easily relocatable.
1284
1285 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1286 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1287 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1288 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1289 consistent across all configuration files.
1290
1291 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1292 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1293 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1294 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1295 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1296 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1297 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1298 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1299
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001300description <text>
1301 Add a text that describes the instance.
1302
1303 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1304 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1305 "<" and ">" characters.
1306
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001307deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1308 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001309 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001310
1311deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001312 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001313 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1314
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001315deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001316 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1317 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1318 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001319
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001320deviceatlas-separator <char>
1321 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1322 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1323
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001324expose-experimental-directives
1325 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1326 the config file will be rejected.
1327
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001328external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001329 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1330 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001331 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1332 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1333 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1334 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1335 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001337gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001338 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001339 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1340 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001341 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001342 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001343 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001344
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001345group <group name>
1346 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1347 See also "gid" and "user".
1348
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001349h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1350 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1351 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1352 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1353 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001354 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001355 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1356 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1357 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1358 specified in a proxy.
1359
1360 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1361 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1362 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1363 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1364 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1365 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1366 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1367
1368 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1369 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1370 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1371 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1372 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1373
1374 Example:
1375 global
1376 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1377
1378 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1379 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1380
1381h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1382 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1383 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1384 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1385 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1386 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1387 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1388 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1389 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1390
1391 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1392 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1393 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1394
1395 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1396 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1397
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001398h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1399 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1400 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1401 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1402 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1403 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1404 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1405 the keyword with "no'.
1406
1407hard-stop-after <time>
1408 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1409
1410 Arguments :
1411 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1412 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1413 SIGUSR1 signal.
1414
1415 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1416 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1417 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1418
1419 Example:
1420 global
1421 hard-stop-after 30s
1422
1423 See also: grace
1424
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001425insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001426 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001427 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1428 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1429 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1430 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1431 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1432 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1433 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001434 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001435 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1436 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1437 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1438 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1439 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1440 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1441 disable it.
1442
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001443insecure-setuid-wanted
1444 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1445 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1446 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1447 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001448 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001449 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001450 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001451 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1452 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001453 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001454 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1455 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1456 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1457 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1458
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001459issuers-chain-path <dir>
1460 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1461 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1462 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001463 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001464 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1465 "issuers-chain-path".
1466 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1467 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1468 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1469 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1470 will share the chain in memory.
1471
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001472localpeer <name>
1473 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1474 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1475 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1476 the configuration parsing.
1477
1478 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1479 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1480
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001481log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001482 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001483 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001484 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001485 configured with "log global".
1486
1487 <address> can be one of:
1488
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001489 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001490 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1491 port).
1492
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001493 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1494 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1495 port).
1496
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001497 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001498 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1499 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001500 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001501
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001502 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1503 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1504 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1505 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1506 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1507 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1508 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1509 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1510 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1511 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001512 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001513 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1514 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1515 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001516 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1517 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001518
1519 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1520 "fd@2", see above.
1521
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001522 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1523 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1524 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1525 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1526 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1527
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001528 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1529 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001530
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001531 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1532 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1533 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1534 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1535 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1536 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1537 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1538 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1539 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1540 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001541 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1542 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001543
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001544 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1545 one of the following :
1546
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001547 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1548 field is stripped. This is the default.
1549 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1550 rfc3164.
1551
1552 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001553 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1554
1555 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1556 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1557
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001558 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1559 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1560 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1561 designed to be used with a local log server.
1562
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001563 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1564 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1565 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1566 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1567 logger consumes.
1568
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001569 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1570 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1571 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1572 used with a local log server.
1573
1574 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1575 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1576 designed to be used with a local log server.
1577
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001578 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1579 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1580 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1581 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1582
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001583 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1584 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1585 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1586 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1587 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1588
1589 <sample_size>
1590 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1591 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1592 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1593 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1594 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1595
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001596 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001597
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001598 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1599 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1600 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1601
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001602 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1603 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1604 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1605 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001606
1607 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001608 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1609 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1610 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1611 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1612 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1613 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001614
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001615 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001617log-send-hostname [<string>]
1618 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1619 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1620 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1621 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1622 the logs.
1623
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001624log-tag <string>
1625 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1626 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1627 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001628 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001629
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001630lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001631 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1632 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1633 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1634 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1635 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1636 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001637 used multiple times.
1638
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001639lua-load-per-thread <file>
1640 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1641 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1642 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1643 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1644 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1645 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1646 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1647 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1648 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1649 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1650 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1651 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1652 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1653 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1654 times.
1655
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001656lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1657 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1658 variable.
1659 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1660 to "path".
1661
1662 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1663 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1664 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1665 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1666 will be checked earlier.
1667
1668 As an example by specifying the following path:
1669
1670 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1671 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1672
1673 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1674 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1675 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1676 paths if that does not exist either.
1677
1678 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1679 documentation.
1680
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001681master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001682 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1683 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1684 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001685 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001686 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1687 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001688 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1689 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1690 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1691 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1692 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001693
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001694 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001695
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001696mworker-max-reloads <number>
1697 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001698 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001699 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1700 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1701 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1702
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001703nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001704 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1705 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1706 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001707 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1708 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001709 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1710 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1711 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001712
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001713nbthread <number>
1714 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001715 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001716 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1717 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1718 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1719 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001720 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1721 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1722 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1723 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1724 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1725 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1726 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001727
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001728numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001729 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001730 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1731 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1732 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1733 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1734 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1735 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1736 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1737 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1738
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001739pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001740 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1741 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1742 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1743 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001744
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001745pp2-never-send-local
1746 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1747 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1748 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1749 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1750 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1751 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1752 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1753 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1754 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1755 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1756 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1757
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001758presetenv <name> <value>
1759 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1760 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1761 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1762 and "unsetenv".
1763
1764resetenv [<name> ...]
1765 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1766 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1767 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1768 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1769 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1770 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1771 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1772 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1773
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001774stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001775 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1776 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1777 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1778 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1779 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1780 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001781 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001782 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1783 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1784 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1785 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001786
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001787server-state-base <directory>
1788 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001789 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1790 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001791
1792server-state-file <file>
1793 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1794 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1795 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1796 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1797 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1798 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1799 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1800 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001801 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1802 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001803
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001804set-dumpable
1805 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1806 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1807 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1808 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1809 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1810 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1811 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1812 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1813 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1814 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1815 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1816 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1817 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1818 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1819 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1820 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1821 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
1822 leaves a core where expected when dying.
1823
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001824set-var <var-name> <expr>
1825 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1826 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1827 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1828 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1829 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1830 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1831 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1832 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1833 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1834
1835 Example:
1836 global
1837 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1838 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1839 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1840
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001841setenv <name> <value>
1842 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1843 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1844 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1845 and "unsetenv".
1846
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001847ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1849 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001850 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001851 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001852 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1853 information and recommendations see e.g.
1854 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1855 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1856 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1857 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001858
1859ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1860 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1861 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1862 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1863 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1864 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001865 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1866 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1867 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001868 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001869
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001870ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1872 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1873 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1874 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1875 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1876
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001877ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1879 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1880 keyword to see available options.
1881
1882 Example:
1883 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001884 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001885
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001886ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1888 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001889 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001890 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001891 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1892 information and recommendations see e.g.
1893 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1894 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1895 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1896 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1897 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001898
1899ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1901 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1902 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1903 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1904 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001905 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1906 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1907 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1908 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001909
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001910ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1911 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1912 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1913 keyword to see available options.
1914
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001915ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1917 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1918 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001919 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001920 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001921 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1922 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1923 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1924 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001925 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1926 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1927 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1928
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001929ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1930 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1931 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001932 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001933 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001934 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1935
1936 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001937
1938 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1939 and won't try to remove them.
1940
1941 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1942
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001943ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001944 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001945 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1946 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1947 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001948
1949 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1950 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1951 optimize the startup time.
1952
1953 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1954 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1955 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1956
1957 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001958 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001959
1960 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001961 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1962 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001963
1964 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1965 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1966 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1967 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1968 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001969 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001970
1971 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001972 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001973 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1974 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1975 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1976 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1977 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001978 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001979
1980 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1981
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001982 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001983 a cert bundle.
1984
1985 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1986 separately in several "crt".
1987
1988 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1989 since files are loading separately.
1990
1991 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1992 required to commit them.
1993
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001994 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001995 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001996
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001997 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1998 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1999 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002000
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002001 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2002 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2003 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002004
2005 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002006 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2007 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002008
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002009 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2010 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2011
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002012 The default behavior is "all".
2013
2014 Example:
2015 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2016 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2017 ssl-load-extra-files none
2018
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002019 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2020 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002021
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002022ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2023 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2024 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2025 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2026
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002027ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002028 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002029 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2030 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2031 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2032 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2033 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2034 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002035 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002036
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002037stats maxconn <connections>
2038 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2039 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2040
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002041stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2042 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2043 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2044 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002045 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002046 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002047
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002048 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2049 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2050 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002051
2052stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2053 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2054 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002055 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002056
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002057strict-limits
2058 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2059 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2060 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2061 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2062 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002063
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002064uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002065 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002066 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2067 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2068 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2069
2070ulimit-n <number>
2071 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2072 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2073 option.
2074
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002075unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2076 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2077
2078 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2079 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2080 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2081 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2082 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002083 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002084 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2085 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2086 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2087 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2088
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002089unsetenv [<name> ...]
2090 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2091 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2092 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2093 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2094 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2095 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2096 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2097
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002098user <user name>
2099 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2100 See also "uid" and "group".
2101
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002102node <name>
2103 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2104
2105 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2106 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2107 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2108 traffic.
2109
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002110wurfl-cache-size <size>
2111 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2112 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2113 - "0" : no cache is used.
2114 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002115
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002116 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2117 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002118
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002119wurfl-data-file <file path>
2120 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2121 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2122
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002123 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002124 with USE_WURFL=1.
2125
2126wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2127 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2128 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2129 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2130
2131 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2132
2133 Valid WURFL properties are:
2134 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2135
2136 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2137 device.
2138
2139 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2140 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2141
2142 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2143 particular web request.
2144
2145 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2146 used Libwurfl API version.
2147
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002148 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2149 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2150
2151 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2152 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2153
2154 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2155
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002156 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002157 with USE_WURFL=1.
2158
2159wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2160 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2161 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2162
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002163 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002164 with USE_WURFL=1.
2165
2166wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2167 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2168 thus before the chroot.
2169
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002170 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002171 with USE_WURFL=1.
2172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021733.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002174-----------------------
2175
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002176busy-polling
2177 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2178 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2179 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2180 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2181 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2182 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2183 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2184 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2185 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2186 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2187 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2188 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2189 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2190 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2191 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2192 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2193 "poll" pollers.
2194
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002195 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2196 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2197 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2198
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002199max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002200 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002201 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2202 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2203 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2204 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2205 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2206 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2207 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2208
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002209maxcompcpuusage <number>
2210 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2211 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2212 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2213 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2214 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2215 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2216 and from introducing high latencies.
2217
2218maxcomprate <number>
2219 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2220 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2221 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2222 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2223 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2224 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2225 default value.
2226
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002227maxconn <number>
2228 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2229 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2230 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002231 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2232 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2233 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2234 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002235 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2236 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2237 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2238 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2239 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2240 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002241
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002242maxconnrate <number>
2243 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2244 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2245 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2246 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2247 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2248 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2249 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2250 fairness.
2251
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002252maxpipes <number>
2253 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2254 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2255 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2256 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2257 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2258 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2259
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002260maxsessrate <number>
2261 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2262 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2263 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2264 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2265 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2266 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2267 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2268 fairness.
2269
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002270maxsslconn <number>
2271 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2272 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2273 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2274 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2275 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2276 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2277 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002278 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2279 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2280 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2281 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002282 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002283 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2284 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002285
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002286maxsslrate <number>
2287 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2288 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2289 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2290 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2291 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2292 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2293 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2294 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2295 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2296 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2297
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002298maxzlibmem <number>
2299 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2300 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2301 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002302 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2303 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2304 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2305
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002306no-memory-trimming
2307 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2308 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2309 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2310 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2311 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2312 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2313 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2314 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2315 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2316 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2317 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2318 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2319 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2320 not suffer from such a problem.
2321
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002322noepoll
2323 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2324 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002325 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002326
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002327noevports
2328 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2329 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2330 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2331 also "nopoll".
2332
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002333nogetaddrinfo
2334 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2335 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2336
2337nokqueue
2338 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2339 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2340 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2341
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002342nopoll
2343 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2344 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002346 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2347 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002348
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002349noreuseport
2350 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2351 command line argument "-dR".
2352
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002353nosplice
2354 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002355 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002356 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002357 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002358 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2359 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2360 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2361 "option splice-response".
2362
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002363profiling.memory { on | off }
2364 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2365 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2366 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2367 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2368 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2369 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2370 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2371 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2372 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2373
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002374profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2375 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2376 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2377 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2378 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002379 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002380 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2381 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2382 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2383 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2384
2385 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2386 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2387 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2388 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2389 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002390 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2391 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2392 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2393 CLI.
2394
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002395spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002396 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2397 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2398 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2399 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2400 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2401 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002402
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002403ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002404 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002405 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002406 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002407 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002408 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2409 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2410 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002411 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2412 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002413 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2414 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2415 openssl configuration file uses:
2416 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2417
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002418ssl-mode-async
2419 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002420 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002421 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2422 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002423 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002424 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002425 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002426
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002427tune.buffers.limit <number>
2428 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2429 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2430 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2431 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2432 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002433 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002434 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2435 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2436 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2437 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2438 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2439 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2440 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2441 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002442 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002443
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002444tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2445 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2446 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2447 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002448 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002449
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002450tune.bufsize <number>
2451 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2452 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2453 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2454 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2455 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2456 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2457 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002458 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2459 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002460 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002461 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002462 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002463 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2464 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002465
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002466tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2467 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002468
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002469tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2470 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2471 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2472 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2473 this value. The default value is 1.
2474
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002475tune.fail-alloc
2476 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2477 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2478 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2479 gracefully.
2480
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002481tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2482 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2483 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2484 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2485 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2486 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2487
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002488tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2489 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2490 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2491 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2492 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2493 change it.
2494
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002495tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2496 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002497 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002498 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002499 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2500 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2501 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2502 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2503 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2504
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002505tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2506 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2507 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2508 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2509 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2510 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002511 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002512 recommended not to change this value.
2513
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002514tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002515 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002516 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002517 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002518 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2519 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2520 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2521 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2522
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002523tune.http.cookielen <number>
2524 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2525 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2526 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2527 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2528 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2529 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2530 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2531 to change this value.
2532
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002533tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002534 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2535 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002536 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002537 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002538 configuration directives too.
2539 The default value is 1024.
2540
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002541tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2542 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2543 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2544 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2545 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2546 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2547 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002548 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2549 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2550 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002551
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002552tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2553 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2554 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2555 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2556 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2557 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2558 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002559 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2560 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2561 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2562 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2563 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002564
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002565tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002566 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002567 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2568 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2569 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2570 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002571 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002572 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002573 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002574 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2575
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002576tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2577 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2578 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2579 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2580 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2581 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2582 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2583 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2584 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2585 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2586
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002587tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2588 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002589 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002590 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2591 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002592 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002593 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2594 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2595
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002596tune.lua.maxmem
2597 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2598 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2599 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2600 memory.
2601
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002602tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2603 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002604 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2605 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002606 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002607
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002608tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2609 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2610 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2611 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002612 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002613
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002614tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2615 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2616 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2617 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2618 check servers.
2619
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002620tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002621 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2622 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002623 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2624 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2625 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2626 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2627 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2628 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2629 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2630 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2631 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002632
2633tune.maxpollevents <number>
2634 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2635 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2636 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2637 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2638 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2639
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002640tune.maxrewrite <number>
2641 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2642 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2643 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2644 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2645 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2646 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2647 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2648 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2649 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2650 bufsize.
2651
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002652tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2653 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2654 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2655 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2656 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2657 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2658 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2659 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2660 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2661 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002662 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2663 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002664 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2665 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2666 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2667 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2668 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2669 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2670 setting this parameter to 0.
2671
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002672tune.pipesize <number>
2673 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2674 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2675 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2676 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2677 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2678 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2679
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002680tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2681 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002682 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002683 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2684 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2685 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2686 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002687 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002688
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002689tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2690 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002691 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002692 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2693 default is 20.
2694
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002695tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2696tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2697 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2698 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2699 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002700 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002701 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002702 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2703 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2704
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002705tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002706 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002707 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2708 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2709 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2710 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2711
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002712tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002713 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002714 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2715 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2716 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2717 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2718 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2719 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2720 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002721
2722tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2723 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002724 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002725 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2726 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2727 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2728 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2729 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2730 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2731 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002732
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002733tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2734tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2735 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2736 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2737 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002738 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002739 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002740 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2741 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2742 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2743 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002744 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002745
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002746tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002747 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002748 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2749 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2750 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2751 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2752 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2753 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2754 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2755 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2756 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2757 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2758 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002759
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002760tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2761 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2762 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2763 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2764 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2765
2766tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2767 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2768 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2769 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2770 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2771 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
2772 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
2773 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
2774 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
2775 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
2776 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
2777 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
2778 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
2779
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002780tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002781 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002782 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2783 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2784 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2785 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2786 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2787
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002788tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2789 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2790 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2791 performances. This is disabled by default.
2792
2793 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2794 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2795
2796 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2797
2798 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2799
2800 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2801
2802 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2803 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2804 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2805
2806 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2807 converted.
2808
2809 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2810 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2811 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2812 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2813 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2814 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2815 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002816 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2817 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002818
2819 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2820
2821 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2822 only need this line:
2823
2824 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2825
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002826tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2827 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002828 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002829 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2830 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2831 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2832 being used for too long.
2833
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002834tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2835 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2836 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2837 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2838 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2839 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2840 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2841 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2842 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2843 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2844 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002845 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002846 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002847
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002848tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2849 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2850 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2851 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2852 1000 entries.
2853
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002854tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002855tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002856tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2857tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2858tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002859 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2860 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2861 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2862 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2863 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2864 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2865 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2866 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002867
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002868 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2869 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2870 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2871 all available space is consumed.
2872 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2873 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2874 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002875
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002876tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2877 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002878 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002879 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002880 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002881 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2882
2883tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2884 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2885 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002886 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2887 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028893.3. Debugging
2890--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002891
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002892quiet
2893 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2894 line argument "-q".
2895
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002896zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002897 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002898 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2899 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2900 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2901 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2902 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2903
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002904
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029053.4. Userlists
2906--------------
2907It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2908http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2909it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2910
2911userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002912 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002913 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2914
2915group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002916 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2918 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2919
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002920user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2921 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002922 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2923 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002924 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2925 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2926 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2927 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002928
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002929 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2930 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2931 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2932 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2933 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2934 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2935 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002936 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002937 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002938
2939 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002940 userlist L1
2941 group G1 users tiger,scott
2942 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002943
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002944 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2945 user scott insecure-password elgato
2946 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002947
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002948 userlist L2
2949 group G1
2950 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002951
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002952 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2953 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2954 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002955
2956 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002957
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002958
29593.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002960----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002961It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002962several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002963instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2964values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2965automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2966In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2967using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2968tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2969reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2970Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2971that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2972each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002973
2974peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002975 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002976 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2977
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002978bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2979 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2980 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2981
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002982disabled
2983 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2984 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2985 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2986
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002987default-bind [param*]
2988 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2989
2990default-server [param*]
2991 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2992
2993 Arguments:
2994 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2995 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02002996 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
2997 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
2998 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
2999 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003000
3001 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3002
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003003enabled
3004 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3005 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003006
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003007log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003008 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3009 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3010 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3011 more details.
3012
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003013peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003014 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3015 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003016 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003017 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003018 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3019 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3020 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003021
3022 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3023 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3024
3025 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003026 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3027 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3028 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003029
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003030 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3031 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003032
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003033 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3034 "server" keyword explanation below).
3035
3036server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003037 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003038 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3039 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3040 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3041 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003042
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003043 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3044 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3045 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3046 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3047 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003048
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003049 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003050 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003051 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003052 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3053 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3054 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003055
3056 backend mybackend
3057 mode tcp
3058 balance roundrobin
3059 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3060 stick on src
3061
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003062 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3063 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003064
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003065 Example:
3066 peers mypeers
Emeric Brun6ca8ba42022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003067 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3068 default-server ssl verify none
3069 server haproxy1 #local peer
3070 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3071 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003072
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003073
3074table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3075 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3076
3077 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3078 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003079 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003080 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3081 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3082 "stick-table" keyword).
3083
3084 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3085 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3086 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3087 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3088 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3089 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3090 of the stick-table name as follows:
3091
3092 peers mypeers
3093 peer A ...
3094 peer B ...
3095 table t1 ...
3096
3097 frontend fe1
3098 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3099
3100 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3101 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3102
3103 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3104 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3105 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3106 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3107 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3108 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3109 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3110
3111 peers mypeers
3112 peer A ...
3113 peer B ...
3114 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3115
3116 backend t1
3117 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3118
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003119 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003120 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3121 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3122
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031233.6. Mailers
3124------------
3125It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3126If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3127in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3128
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003129mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003130 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3131 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3132
3133mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3134 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3135
3136 Example:
3137 mailers mymailers
3138 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3139 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3140
3141 backend mybackend
3142 mode tcp
3143 balance roundrobin
3144
3145 email-alert mailers mymailers
3146 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3147 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3148
3149 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3150 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3151
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003152timeout mail <time>
3153 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3154 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3155 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3156 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3157
3158 Example:
3159 mailers mymailers
3160 timeout mail 20s
3161 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003162
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031633.7. Programs
3164-------------
3165In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3166master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3167managed the same way as the workers.
3168
3169During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3170sequence as a worker:
3171
3172 - the master is re-executed
3173 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3174 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3175 instance of the program
3176
3177During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3178
3179program <name>
3180 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3181 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3182 the management guide).
3183
3184command <command> [arguments*]
3185 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3186 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3187 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3188 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3189
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003190user <user name>
3191 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3192 See also "group".
3193
3194group <group name>
3195 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3196 See also "user".
3197
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003198option start-on-reload
3199no option start-on-reload
3200 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3201 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3202 program section.
3203
3204
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032053.8. HTTP-errors
3206----------------
3207
3208It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3209imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3210several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3211
3212http-errors <name>
3213 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3214 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3215
3216errorfile <code> <file>
3217 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3218
3219 Arguments :
3220 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003221 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003222 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003223
3224 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3225 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3226 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3227 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3228 before any chroot is performed.
3229
3230 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3231
3232 Example:
3233 http-errors website-1
3234 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3235 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3236 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3237
3238 http-errors website-2
3239 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3240 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3241 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3242
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032433.9. Rings
3244----------
3245
3246It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3247servers or traces.
3248
3249ring <ringname>
3250 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3251
3252description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003253 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003254 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3255
3256format <format>
3257 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3258
3259 Arguments:
3260 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3261 one of the following :
3262
3263 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3264 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3265 designed to be used with a local log server.
3266
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003267 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3268 field is stripped. This is the default.
3269 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3270 rfc3164.
3271
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003272 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3273 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3274 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3275 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3276 is the default.
3277
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003278 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003279 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3280
3281 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3282 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3283
3284 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3285 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3286 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3287 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3288 logger consumes.
3289
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003290 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3291 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3292 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3293 with a local log server.
3294
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003295 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3296 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3297 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3298 used with a local log server.
3299
3300maxlen <length>
3301 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3302 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3303 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3304
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003305server <name> <address> [param*]
3306 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3307 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3308 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3309 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3310 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3311 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3312 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3313 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3314 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003315 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3316 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003317
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003318size <size>
3319 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3320 set to BUFSIZE.
3321
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003322timeout connect <timeout>
3323 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3324
3325 Arguments :
3326 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3328 as explained at the top of this document.
3329
3330timeout server <timeout>
3331 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3332
3333 Arguments :
3334 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3335 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3336 as explained at the top of this document.
3337
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003338 Example:
3339 global
3340 log ring@myring local7
3341
3342 ring myring
3343 description "My local buffer"
3344 format rfc3164
3345 maxlen 1200
3346 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003347 timeout connect 5s
3348 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003349 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003350
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033513.10. Log forwarding
3352-------------------
3353
3354It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003355HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003356
3357log-forward <name>
3358 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3359
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003360backlog <conns>
3361 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3362 on connections accept.
3363
3364bind <addr> [param*]
3365 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003366 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3367 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3368 syslog protocol over TCP.
3369 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003370 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3371
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003372dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003373 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3374 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3375 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3376 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003377 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003378
3379log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003380log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003381 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3382 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3383 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003384 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003385 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3386 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3387 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003388 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003389
3390 Example:
3391 global
3392 log stderr format iso local7
3393
3394 ring myring
3395 description "My local buffer"
3396 format rfc5424
3397 maxlen 1200
3398 size 32764
3399 timeout connect 5s
3400 timeout server 10s
3401 # syslog tcp server
3402 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3403
3404 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003405 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3406 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003407 # all messages on stderr
3408 log global
3409 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3410 log ring@myring local0
3411 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3412 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3413 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3414 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3415 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003416
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003417maxconn <conns>
3418 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3419 10 is the default.
3420
3421timeout client <timeout>
3422 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034244. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003425----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003426
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003427Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003428 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3429 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3430 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3431 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003432
3433A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3434connections.
3435
3436A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3437to forward incoming connections.
3438
3439A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3440parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3441
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003442A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3443ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3444sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3445the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3446explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3447from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3448"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3449for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3450to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3451optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3452are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3453any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3454names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3455that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3456duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3457names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3458
3459Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3460settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3461of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3462profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3463timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3464
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3466'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3467case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3468
3469Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3470logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3471proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3472However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3473name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3474
3475Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3476and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003477bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003478protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3479modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3480arbitrary criteria.
3481
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003482In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3483a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003484the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003485
3486 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3487 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3488 between responses and new requests.
3489
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003490 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3491 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3492 client-facing connection remains open.
3493
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003494 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3495 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003496
3497The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3498frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3499following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003500weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003501
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003502 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003503
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003504 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3505 ----+-----+-----+----
3506 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3507 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003508 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3509 ----+-----+-----+----
3510 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003511
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003512It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003513only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3514within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003515as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003516content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003517and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3518possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003520There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003521first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003522processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003523second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003524protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3525is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3526new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003527to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003528process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3529already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3530HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3531evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3532one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3533
3534There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3535performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3536tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3537preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3538analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3539HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3540header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3541mitigate this drawback.
3542
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003543There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003544method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3545set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3546in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3547is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3548to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3549above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3550to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3551"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3552frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3553frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3554as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3555upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3556on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3557the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3558upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3559frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3560remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035624.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3563--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003565The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3566limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3567they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3568limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003569marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003570option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003571and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3572with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3573specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003575
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003576 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3577------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3578acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003579backlog X X X -
3580balance X - X X
3581bind - X X -
3582bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003583capture cookie - X X -
3584capture request header - X X -
3585capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003586clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3587clitcpka-idle X X X -
3588clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003589compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003590cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003591declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003592default-server X - X X
3593default_backend X X X -
3594description - X X X
3595disabled X X X X
3596dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003597email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003598email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003599email-alert mailers X X X X
3600email-alert myhostname X X X X
3601email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003602enabled X X X X
3603errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003604errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605errorloc X X X X
3606errorloc302 X X X X
3607-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3608errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003609force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003610filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003611fullconn X - X X
3612grace X X X X
3613hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003614http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003615http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003616http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003617http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003618http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003619http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003620http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003621http-check set-var X - X X
3622http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003623http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003624http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003625http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003626http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003627http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003628id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003629ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003630load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003631log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003632log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003633log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003634log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003635max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003636maxconn X X X -
3637mode X X X X
3638monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003639monitor-uri X X X -
3640option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3641option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3642option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3643option allbackups (*) X - X X
3644option checkcache (*) X - X X
3645option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3646option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003647option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003648option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3649option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003650-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3651option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003652option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3653option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003654option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003655option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003656option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003657option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003658option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003659option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003660option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3661option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3662option httpchk X - X X
3663option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003664option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003665option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003666option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003667option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003668option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003669option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3670option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3671option logasap (*) X X X -
3672option mysql-check X - X X
3673option nolinger (*) X X X X
3674option originalto X X X X
3675option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003676option pgsql-check X - X X
3677option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003678option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003679option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003680option smtpchk X - X X
3681option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3682option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3683option splice-request (*) X X X X
3684option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003685option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003686option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3687option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3688-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003689option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003690option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3691option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3692option tcpka X X X X
3693option tcplog X X X X
3694option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003695option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003696external-check command X - X X
3697external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003698persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3699rate-limit sessions X X X -
3700redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003701-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003702retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003703retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003704server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003705server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003706server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003707source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003708srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3709srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3710srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003711stats admin - X X X
3712stats auth X X X X
3713stats enable X X X X
3714stats hide-version X X X X
3715stats http-request - X X X
3716stats realm X X X X
3717stats refresh X X X X
3718stats scope X X X X
3719stats show-desc X X X X
3720stats show-legends X X X X
3721stats show-node X X X X
3722stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003723-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3724stick match - - X X
3725stick on - - X X
3726stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003727stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003728stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003729tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003730tcp-check connect X - X X
3731tcp-check expect X - X X
3732tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003733tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003734tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003735tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003736tcp-check set-var X - X X
3737tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003738tcp-request connection - X X -
3739tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003740tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003741tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003742tcp-response content - - X X
3743tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003744timeout check X - X X
3745timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003746timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003747timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003748timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3749timeout http-request X X X X
3750timeout queue X - X X
3751timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003752timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003753timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003754timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003755transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003756unique-id-format X X X -
3757unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003758use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003759use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003760use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003761------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3762 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003763
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037654.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3766---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003767
3768This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3769
3770
3771acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3772 Declare or complete an access list.
3773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3774 no | yes | yes | yes
3775 Example:
3776 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3777 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3778 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003780 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003781
3782
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003783backlog <conns>
3784 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3786 yes | yes | yes | no
3787 Arguments :
3788 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3789 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003790 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003791
3792 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3793 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3794 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3795 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3796 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3797 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3798 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3799 backlog parameter.
3800
3801 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3802 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3803 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3804
3805 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3806
3807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003808balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003809balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003810 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3812 yes | no | yes | yes
3813 Arguments :
3814 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3815 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3816 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3817 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3818
3819 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3820 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3821 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3822 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003823 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003824 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003825 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3826 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3827 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3828 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3829 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3830 it, so that you don't worry.
3831
3832 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3833 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3834 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3835 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3836 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3837 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3838 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3839 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003840
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003841 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3842 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3843 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3844 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3845 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3846 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3847 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003848 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3849 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3850 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003851
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003852 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003853 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003854 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3855 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003856 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003857 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3858 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3859 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3860 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3861 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003862 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3863 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3864 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3865 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3866 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3867 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003868
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003869 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3870 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3871 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3872 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3873 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3874 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3875 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3876 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003877 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003878 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003879 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3880 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3881 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003882
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003883 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3884 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3885 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3886 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3887 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3888 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3889 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3890 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3891 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3892 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3893 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3894 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003895
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003896 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003897 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3898 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3899 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3900 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3901 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3902 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3903 URIs start with a leading "/".
3904
3905 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3906 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3907 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3908 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3909
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003910 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3911 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3912 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3913 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3914
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003915 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003916 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3917
3918 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003919 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3920 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003921 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3922 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3923 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3924 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003925 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003926 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3927 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003928
3929 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3930 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3931 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3932 server will receive the request.
3933
3934 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3935 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3936 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3937 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3938 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003939 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3940 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3941 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003942
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003943 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3944 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3945 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3946 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3947 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003948
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003949 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003950 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3951 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3952 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3953
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003954 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3955 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3956 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3957
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003958 random
3959 random(<draws>)
3960 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003961 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3962 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3963 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3964 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003965 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3966 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3967 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3968 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3969 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3970 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3971 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3972 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3973 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3974 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3975 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3976 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3977 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3978 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3979 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3980 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3981 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3982 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3983 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3984 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003985
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003986 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003987 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003988 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3989 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003990 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003991 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3992 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3993 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003994 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003995 used instead.
3996
3997 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3998 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3999 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004000 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004001
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004002 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4003 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4004 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4005
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004006 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004007 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4008 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004009
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004010 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4011 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4012 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004013
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004014 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004015 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004016 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4017 NTLM relies on.
4018
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004019 Examples :
4020 balance roundrobin
4021 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004022 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004023 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4024 balance hdr(host)
4025 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004026
4027 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4028 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004030 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004031 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4032 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4033 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004034 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004035
4036 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4037 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4038 defaults to 16 kB.
4039
4040 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4041 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4042
4043 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4044 Round Robin.
4045
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004046 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004047 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4048 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4049 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4050
4051 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4052
4053 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004054 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004055 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4056 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4057 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004058
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004059 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004060
4061
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004062bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4063bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004064 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4066 no | yes | yes | no
4067 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004068 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4069 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4070 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4071 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004072 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004073 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4074 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4075 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4076 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4077 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4078 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004079 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004080 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4081 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004082 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004083 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4084 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004085 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004086 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4087 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004088 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004089 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4090 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4091 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4092 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4093 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4094 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4095 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004096 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4097 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4098 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004099 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4100 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4101 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4102 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004103 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4104 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4105 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004106
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004107 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4108 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004109 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4110 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4111 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004112 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4113 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4114 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4115 the range.
4116
4117 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4118 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4119 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4120 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4121 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4122 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4123 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004124 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004125 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004126
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004127 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004128 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004129 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4130 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4131 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4132 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4133 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4134 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4135
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004136 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4137 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4138 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4139 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004140
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004141 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4142 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4143 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4144 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4145 in a frontend.
4146
4147 Example :
4148 listen http_proxy
4149 bind :80,:443
4150 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004151 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004152
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004153 listen http_https_proxy
4154 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004155 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004156
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004157 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4158 bind ipv6@:80
4159 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4160 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4161
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004162 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004163 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004164
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004165 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4166 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4167 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4168 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4169 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4170
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004171 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004172 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004173
4174
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004175bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004176 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4178 yes | yes | yes | yes
4179 Arguments :
4180 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4181 may be used to override a default value.
4182
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004183 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004184 option may be combined with other numbers.
4185
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004186 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004187 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4188 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4189 missing from all processes.
4190
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004191 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004192 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004193 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4194 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4195 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4196 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4197 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004198 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004199
4200 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4201 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4202 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4203 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4204 and 'even' instances.
4205
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004206 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4207 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4208 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4209 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004210
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004211 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4212 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4213
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004214 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4215 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4216 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4217
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004218 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4219 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4220
4221 Example :
4222 listen app_ip1
4223 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004224 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004225
4226 listen app_ip2
4227 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004228 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004229
4230 listen management
4231 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004232 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004233
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004234 listen management
4235 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4236 bind-process 1-4
4237
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004238 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004239
4240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004241capture cookie <name> len <length>
4242 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4244 no | yes | yes | no
4245 Arguments :
4246 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4247 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4248 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4249 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004250 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004251
4252 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4253 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4254 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4255 right if it exceeds <length>.
4256
4257 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4258 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4259 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4260 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4261
4262 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4263 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4264 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4265
4266 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4267 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4268 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004269 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4270 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4271 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004272
4273 Example:
4274 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4275
4276 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004277 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004278
4279
4280capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004281 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 no | yes | yes | no
4284 Arguments :
4285 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004286 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004287 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4288 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4289 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4290
4291 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4292 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4293 it exceeds <length>.
4294
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004295 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004296 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4297 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004298 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4299 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4300 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4301 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004302 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004303 environments to find where the request came from.
4304
4305 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4306 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4307 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4308 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004310 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4311 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4312 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4313 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4314 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004315
4316 Example:
4317 capture request header Host len 15
4318 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004319 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004321 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004322 about logging.
4323
4324
4325capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004326 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4328 no | yes | yes | no
4329 Arguments :
4330 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004331 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004332 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4333 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4334 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4335
4336 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4337 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4338 it exceeds <length>.
4339
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004340 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004341 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4342 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4343 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004344 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4345 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4346 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4347 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004348
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004349 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4350 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4351 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4352 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4353 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004354
4355 Example:
4356 capture response header Content-length len 9
4357 capture response header Location len 15
4358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004359 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004360 about logging.
4361
4362
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004363clitcpka-cnt <count>
4364 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4365 the connection on the client side.
4366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4367 yes | yes | yes | no
4368 Arguments :
4369 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4370
4371 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4372 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004373 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4374 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004375
4376 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4377
4378
4379clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4380 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4381 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4382 client side.
4383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4384 yes | yes | yes | no
4385 Arguments :
4386 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4387 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4388 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4389 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4390
4391 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4392 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004393 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4394 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004395
4396 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4397
4398
4399clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4400 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4402 yes | yes | yes | no
4403 Arguments :
4404 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4405 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4406 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4407 document.
4408
4409 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4410 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004411 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4412 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004413
4414 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4415
4416
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004417compression algo <algorithm> ...
4418compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004419compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004420 Enable HTTP compression.
4421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4422 yes | yes | yes | yes
4423 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004424 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4425 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004426 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004427
4428 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004429 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4430 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4431 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004432
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004433 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004434 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004435
4436 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4437 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4438 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4439 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4440 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004441 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004442
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004443 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4444 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4445 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4446 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4447 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4448 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4449 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004450 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004451
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004452 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004453 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004454 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004455 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004456 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004457 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004458 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004459
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004460 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004461 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4462 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004463 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4464 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004465 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004466 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004467 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4468 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004469 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004470 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4471 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004472
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004473 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004474 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4475 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004476 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004477 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004478 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4479 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4480 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4481 "multipart"
4482 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4483 header
4484 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4485 and later
4486 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4487 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004488 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004489
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004490 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004491
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004492 Examples :
4493 compression algo gzip
4494 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004495
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004496
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004497cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004498 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4499 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004500 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004501 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4503 yes | no | yes | yes
4504 Arguments :
4505 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4506 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4507 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4508 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4509 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4510 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004511 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004512 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4513 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4514
4515 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004516 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004517 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4518 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4519 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4520 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004521 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4522 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004523 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004524 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4525 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004526
4527 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004528 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004529
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004530 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004531 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004532 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004533 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004534 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4535 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4536 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4537 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4538 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4539 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4540 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004541
4542 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4543 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4544 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4545 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4546 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4547 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4548 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4549 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4550 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004551 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004552 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4553 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4554 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004555
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004556 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4557 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4558 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004559 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4560 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4561 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4562 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004563 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4564 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4565 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004566
4567 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4568 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4569 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4570 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4571 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4572 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4573 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4574 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4575 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4576
4577 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4578 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4579 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4580 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4581 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4582 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4583 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4584 persistence cookie in the cache.
4585 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4586
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004587 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4588 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004589 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004590 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4591 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004592 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004593 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4594 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4595 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4596 they logout.
4597
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004598 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004599 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4600 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4601 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4602
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004603 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004604 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4605 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4606 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4607 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4608 this attribute.
4609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004610 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004611 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004612 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4613 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4614 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4615 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4616 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4617 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004618
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004619 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4620 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4621 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4622 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4623 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4624 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4625 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4626 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004627 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004628 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4629 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4630 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4631 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4632 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4633 the site.
4634
4635 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4636 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4637 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4638 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4639 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4640 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4641 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4642 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4643 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4644 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4645 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4646 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4647 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004648 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004649 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4650 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4651
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004652 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4653 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4654 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4655 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4656 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4657 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4658
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004659 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004660 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4661 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4662 repeated.
4663
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004664 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4665 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4666 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4667 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004668
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004669 Examples :
4670 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4671 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4672 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004673 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004674
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004675 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004676
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004677
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004678declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4679 Declares a capture slot.
4680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4681 no | yes | yes | no
4682 Arguments:
4683 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4684
4685 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4686 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4687 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4688 for use in the response.
4689
4690 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004691 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004692 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4693
4694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004695default-server [param*]
4696 Change default options for a server in a backend
4697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4698 yes | no | yes | yes
4699 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004700 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4701 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4702 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4703 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004704
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004705 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004706 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4707
4708 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004709
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004710
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004711default_backend <backend>
4712 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4714 yes | yes | yes | no
4715 Arguments :
4716 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4717
4718 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4719 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4720 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4721 will catch all undetermined requests.
4722
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004723 Example :
4724
4725 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4726 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4727 default_backend dynamic
4728
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004729 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004730
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004731
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004732description <string>
4733 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4735 no | yes | yes | yes
4736 Arguments : string
4737
4738 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4739 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4740 it describes.
4741 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4742
4743
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004744disabled
4745 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4747 yes | yes | yes | yes
4748 Arguments : none
4749
4750 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4751 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4752 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4753 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4754 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4755 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4756 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4757
4758 See also : "enabled"
4759
4760
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004761dispatch <address>:<port>
4762 Set a default server address
4763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4764 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004765 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004766
4767 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4768 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4769 during start-up.
4770
4771 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4772 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4773 possible with normal servers.
4774
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004775 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004776 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4777 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4778 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4779 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4780
4781 See also : "server"
4782
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004783
4784dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4785 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4787 yes | no | yes | yes
4788 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4789
4790 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004791 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004792 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4793 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004794 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004795 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004797enabled
4798 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4800 yes | yes | yes | yes
4801 Arguments : none
4802
4803 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4804 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4805
4806 See also : "disabled"
4807
4808
4809errorfile <code> <file>
4810 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4812 yes | yes | yes | yes
4813 Arguments :
4814 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004815 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004816 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004817
4818 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004819 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004820 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004821 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4822 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004823
4824 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4825 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4826 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4827
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004828 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4829
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004830 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4831 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4832 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4833 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4834 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4835 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4836 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4837 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4838 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004840 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4841 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4842 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004843 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004844 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4845
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004846 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004847
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004848 Example :
4849 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004850 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004851 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4852 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4853
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004854
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004855errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4856 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4857 section.
4858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4859 yes | yes | yes | yes
4860 Arguments :
4861 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4862
4863 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004864 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004865 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4866 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004867
4868 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4869 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4870 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4871 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4872 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004873 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004874 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4875
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004876 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4877 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004878
4879 Example :
4880 errorfiles generic
4881 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4882
4883
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004884errorloc <code> <url>
4885errorloc302 <code> <url>
4886 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4888 yes | yes | yes | yes
4889 Arguments :
4890 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004891 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004892 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004893
4894 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4895 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4896 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4897 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004898 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004899
4900 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4901 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4902 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4903
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004904 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4905
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004906 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4907 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4908 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4909 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004910 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004911 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4912 request.
4913
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004914 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004915
4916
4917errorloc303 <code> <url>
4918 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4920 yes | yes | yes | yes
4921 Arguments :
4922 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004923 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004924 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004925
4926 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4927 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4928 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4929 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004930 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004931
4932 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4933 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4934 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4935
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004936 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4937
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004938 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4939 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4940 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4941 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004942 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004943
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004944 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004945
4946
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004947email-alert from <emailaddr>
4948 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004949 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 yes | yes | yes | yes
4952
4953 Arguments :
4954
4955 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4956
4957 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4958 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4959
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004960 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004961 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4962 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004963
4964
4965email-alert level <level>
4966 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4967 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4968 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4969 yes | yes | yes | yes
4970
4971 Arguments :
4972
4973 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4974 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4975 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4976
4977 By default level is alert
4978
4979 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4980 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4981 for the proxy.
4982
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004983 Alerts are sent when :
4984
4985 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4986 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4987 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4988 is notice or lower
4989 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4990 and a health check status update occurs
4991
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004992 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4993 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004994 section 3.6 about mailers.
4995
4996
4997email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4998 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4999 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5000 yes | yes | yes | yes
5001
5002 Arguments :
5003
5004 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5005
5006 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5007 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5008
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005009 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5010 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005011
5012
5013email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5014 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5015 mailers.
5016 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5017 yes | yes | yes | yes
5018
5019 Arguments :
5020
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005021 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005022
5023 By default the systems hostname is used.
5024
5025 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5026 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5027 for the proxy.
5028
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005029 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5030 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005031
5032
5033email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005034 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005035 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5036 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5037 yes | yes | yes | yes
5038
5039 Arguments :
5040
5041 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5042
5043 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5044 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5045
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005046 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005047 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5048
5049
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005050force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5051 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5052 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005053 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005054
5055 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5056 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5057 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5058 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5059 marked down for maintenance operations.
5060
5061 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5062 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5063 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5064 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5065 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5066 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5067 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5068 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5069 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5070
5071 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5072 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5073 is used.
5074
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005075 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005076 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005077
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005078
5079filter <name> [param*]
5080 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5082 no | yes | yes | yes
5083 Arguments :
5084 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5085 referenced in section 9.
5086
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005087 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005088 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005089 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5090 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005091
5092 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5093 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5094
5095 Example:
5096 listen
5097 bind *:80
5098
5099 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5100 filter compression
5101 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5102
5103 compression algo gzip
5104 compression offload
5105
5106 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5107
5108 See also : section 9.
5109
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005110
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005111fullconn <conns>
5112 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5114 yes | no | yes | yes
5115 Arguments :
5116 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5117 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5118
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005119 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005120 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005121 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005122 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5123 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5124 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5125 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5126 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005127 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005128
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005129 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005130 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005131 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5132 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5133 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005134
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005135 Example :
5136 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5137 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5138 # connections.
5139 backend dynamic
5140 fullconn 10000
5141 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5142 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5143
5144 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5145
5146
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005147grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005148 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005150 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005151 Arguments :
5152 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5153 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5154 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5155
5156 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5157 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005158 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005159 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5160
5161 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5162 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5163 simplify it.
5164
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005165
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005166hash-balance-factor <factor>
5167 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5169 yes | no | no | yes
5170 Arguments :
5171 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5172 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005173 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005174
5175 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5176 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5177 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5178 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5179 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5180 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5181 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5182
5183 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5184 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5185 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5186 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5187 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5188
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005189 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5190 consistent hashing mechanism.
5191
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005192 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5193
5194
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005195hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005196 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5198 yes | no | yes | yes
5199 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005200 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5201 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005202
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005203 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5204 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5205 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5206 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5207 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5208 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5209 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5210 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5211 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5212 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005213
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005214 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5215 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5216 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5217 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5218 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5219 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5220 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5221 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5222 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5223 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5224 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5225 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5226 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005227 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5228 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005229
5230 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5231
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005232 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005233 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5234 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5235 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005236 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5237 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5238 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005239
5240 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5241 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005242 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5243 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5244 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5245 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5246
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005247 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005248 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5249 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5250 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5251 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5252 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5253 parameter.
5254
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005255 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5256 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5257 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5258 used on strings.
5259
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005260 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5261
5262 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5263 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5264 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5265 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5266 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5267 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5268 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5269 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5270 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5271 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5272 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5273 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005274
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005275 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5276 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5277 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005278
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005279 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005280
5281
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005282http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5283 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5284 ones).
5285
5286 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5287 no | yes | yes | yes
5288
5289 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5290 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5291 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5292 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5293 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5294 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5295
5296 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5297 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5298 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5299
5300 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5301 below.
5302
5303 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5304 instance.
5305
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005306 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5307 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5308 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5309
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005310 Example:
5311 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5312 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5313 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5314
5315http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5316
5317 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5318 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5319 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5320 example, or to pass some internal information.
5321 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5322 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5323 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5324
5325http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5326
5327 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5328 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5329
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005330http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005331
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005332 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5333 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5334 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5335 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5336 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005337
5338http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5339 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5340
5341 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5342
5343 Example:
5344 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5345
5346 # applied to:
5347 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5348
5349 # outputs:
5350 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5351
5352 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5353
5354http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5355 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5356
5357 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5358
5359 Example:
5360 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5361
5362 # applied to:
5363 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5364
5365 # outputs:
5366 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5367
5368http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5369
5370 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5371 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5372 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5373
5374http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5375 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5376
5377 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5378 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5379 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5380 fallback.
5381
5382 Example:
5383 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5384 http-response set-status 431
5385 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5386 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5387
5388http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5389
5390 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5391 inline.
5392
5393 Arguments:
5394 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5395 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5396 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5397 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5398 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5399 (request and response)
5400 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5401 processing
5402 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5403 processing
5404 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5405 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5406 and '_'.
5407
5408 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5409 followed by some converters.
5410
5411 Example:
5412 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5413
5414http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5415
5416 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5417 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5418 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5419 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5420 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005421 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005422 processing.
5423
5424 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5425 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005426 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005427 rules evaluation.
5428
5429http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5430
5431 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5432 details about <var-name>.
5433
5434 Example:
5435 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5436
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005437
5438http-check comment <string>
5439 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5440 it fails.
5441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5442 yes | no | yes | yes
5443
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005444 Arguments :
5445 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5446 rule fails.
5447
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005448 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5449 user-friendly error reporting.
5450
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005451 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005452 "http-check expect".
5453
5454
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005455http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5456 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005457 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005458 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5460 yes | no | yes | yes
5461
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005462 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005463 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5464
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005465 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005466 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005467
5468 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5469 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5470 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5471 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5472
5473 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5474
5475 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5476
5477 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5478
5479 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5480
5481 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5482
5483 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5484 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5485 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5486 is used.
5487
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005488 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5489 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5490 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5491 haproxy -vv.
5492
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005493 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5494
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005495 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5496 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5497 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5498 different ports or with different servers.
5499
5500 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5501 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5502 the port with a "http-check connect".
5503
5504 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5505 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5506 do.
5507
5508 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5509 unset-var or comment rules.
5510
5511 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005512 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5513 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5514 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5515 option httpchk
5516
5517 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005518 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005519 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005520 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005521 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005522 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005523
5524 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5525
5526 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005527
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005529http-check disable-on-404
5530 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005532 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005533 Arguments : none
5534
5535 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5536 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5537 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5538 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5539 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5540 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5541 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5542 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005543 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5544 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005545 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5546 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5547 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005548
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005549 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005550
5551
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005552http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005553 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5554 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5555 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005556 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005558 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005559
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005560 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005561 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5562
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005563 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5564 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5565 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5566 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5567 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5568 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5569 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5570 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5571 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5572 result is always conclusive.
5573
5574 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5575 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5576 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005577 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5578 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005579 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5580 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005581 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5582 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5583 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005584
5585 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5586 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005587 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5588 supported :
5589 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5590 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005591 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5592 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5593 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5594 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5595 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005596
5597 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5598 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005599 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5600 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5601 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5602 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005603 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5604
5605 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5606 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5607 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5608 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5609
5610 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5611 informational message reported in logs if an error
5612 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5613 log-format string.
5614
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005615 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005616 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5617 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005618 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5619 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5620 details on the supported keywords.
5621
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005622 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5623 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5624 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5625 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005626
5627 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5628 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5629 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5630 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5631 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5632
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005633 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5634 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5635 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5636 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5637 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5638 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5639 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005640
5641 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005642 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005643 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5644 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5645 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5646 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5647
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005648 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5649 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005650 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5651 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5652 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5653 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5654 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5655 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5656 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5657 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005658 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5659 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5660 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5661 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5662 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5663 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5664 insensitive on the header names.
5665
5666 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5667 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5668 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5669 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5670 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5671 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005672
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005673 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005674 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005675 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5676 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5677 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5678 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5679 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005680 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005681 trace).
5682
5683 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005684 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005685 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5686 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5687 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5688 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5689 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005690 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005691
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005692 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5693 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5694 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5695 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5696 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5697 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5698
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005699 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005700 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005701 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5702 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5703 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5704 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5705 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5706 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5707
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005708 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5709 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5710 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5711 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5712 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005713
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005714 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5715 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5716
5717 Examples :
5718 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005719 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005720
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005721 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5722 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5723
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005724 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005725 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005726
5727 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005728 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005729
5730 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005731 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005732
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005733 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005734 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005735
5736
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005737http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005738 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5739 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005740 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5741 health checks.
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 yes | no | yes | yes
5744 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005745 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5746
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005747 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5748 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5749 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5750 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5751 to invent non-standard ones.
5752
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005753 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5754 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5755 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5756 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5757
5758 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5759 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5760 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5761 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005762
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005763 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005764 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005765 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005766 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5767 to add it.
5768
5769 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5770 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5771 to the log-format rules.
5772
5773 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5774 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5775 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005776
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005777 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5778 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5779 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5780 request.
5781
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005782 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5783 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5784 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005785 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5786 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5787 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5788 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005789 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005790
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005791 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005792 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5793 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005794
5795 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5796 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5797 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5798 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5799 configured request authority.
5800
5801 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5802 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005803
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005804 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005805
5806
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005807http-check send-state
5808 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5810 yes | no | yes | yes
5811 Arguments : none
5812
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005813 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005814 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005815 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5816 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5817 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005818
5819 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5820 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5821 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5822 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5823 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005824 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5825 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5826 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5827
5828 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5829 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5830 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5831
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005832 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5833 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5834 checked in multiple backends.
5835
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005836 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005837 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5838
5839 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5840 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5841 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5842 one fails.
5843
5844 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5845 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5846 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5847
5848 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5849 server's queue.
5850
5851 Example of a header received by the application server :
5852 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5853 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5854
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005855 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5856 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005857
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005858
5859http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005860 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005861 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5862 yes | no | yes | yes
5863
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005864 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005865 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5866 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5867 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5868 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5869 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5870 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5871 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5872 and '-'.
5873
5874 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5875
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005876 Examples :
5877 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005878
5879
5880http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005881 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005882 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5883 yes | no | yes | yes
5884
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005885 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005886 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5887 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5888 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5889 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5890 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5891 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5892 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5893 and '-'.
5894
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005895 Examples :
5896 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005897
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005898
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005899http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5900 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5901 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5902 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5903 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5905 yes | yes | yes | yes
5906 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005907 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005908 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005909 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005910 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005911
5912 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5913 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5914 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5915 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5916
5917 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5918 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5919 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5920 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5921
5922 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5923 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5924 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5925 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5926 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5927 chroot is performed.
5928
5929 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5930 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5931 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5932 considered.
5933
5934 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5935 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5936 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5937 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5938 considered as a raw string.
5939
5940 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5941 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5942 "content-type".
5943
5944 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5945 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5946 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5947 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5948 evaluated as a log-format string.
5949
5950 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5951 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5952 argument to "content-type".
5953
5954 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5955 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5956 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5957 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5958
5959 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5960 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5961 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5962 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5963 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5964 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5965 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5966 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5967
5968 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5969 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5970 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5971
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005972 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5973 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5974 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5975 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5976 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5977
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005978 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5979 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5980
5981
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005982http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005983 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5984
5985 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5986 no | yes | yes | yes
5987
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005988 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5989 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5990 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5991 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5992 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005994 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5995 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005996
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005997 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005998
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005999 Example:
6000 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6001 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6002 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006004 http-request allow if nagios
6005 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6006 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6007 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006009 Example:
6010 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6011 acl add path /addacl
6012 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006014 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006016 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6017 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006019 Example:
6020 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6021 acl setmap path /setmap
6022 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006026 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6027 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006029 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6030 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006032http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6035 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6036 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6037 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6038 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6039 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6040 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6041 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006045 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6046 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6047 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6048 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6049 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6050 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6051 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6052 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006054http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006056 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6057 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006058
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006059
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006060http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006062 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6063 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6064 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6065 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6066 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006067
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006068 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6069 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6070 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6071 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6072 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6073 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6074 instead.
6075
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006076 Example:
6077 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6078 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006079
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006080http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006081
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006082 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006084http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6085 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006087 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6088 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6089 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6090 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6091 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6092 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6093 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6094 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6095 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006097 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6098 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6099 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006100 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6101
6102 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6103 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6104 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6105 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006107http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006108
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006109 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6110 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6111 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6112 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6113 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6114 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006115
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006116http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006117
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006118 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6119 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6120 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6121 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6122 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006124http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006126 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6127 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6128 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6129 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6130 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6131 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006132
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006133http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6134http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6135 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6136 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6137 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6138 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006139
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006140 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6141 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6142 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006143 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006144 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6145 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6146 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006147 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006148 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006149
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006150http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6151 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6152 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6153 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6154
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006155http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6156
6157 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6158 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6159 pointed by <resolvers>.
6160 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6161 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6162 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6163 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6164 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6165 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6166 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6167 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6168 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6169 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006170 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6171 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006172
6173 Example:
6174 resolvers mydns
6175 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6176 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6177 timeout retry 1s
6178 hold valid 10s
6179 hold nx 3s
6180 hold other 3s
6181 hold obsolete 0s
6182 accepted_payload_size 8192
6183
6184 frontend fe
6185 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006186 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower,regsub(:[0-9]*$,)
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006187 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6188
6189 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6190 # which mean DNS resolution error
6191 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6192
6193 default_backend be
6194
6195 backend b_503
6196 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6197 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6198 # 503 error page to end users
6199
6200 backend be
6201 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6202 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6203 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6204 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6205 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6206
6207 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6208 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6209
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006210http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6211
6212 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6213 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6214 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6215 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006216 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6217 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006218
6219 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6220
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006221http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006222http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006223http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006224http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006225http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006226http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006227http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006228http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6229http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006230
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006231 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6232
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006233 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006234 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6235 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6236 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6237 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006238
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006239 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6240 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6241 the supported backend.
6242
6243 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6244 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6245 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6246 number of segments in the path.
6247
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006248 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6249 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6250 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6251 when improperly combined.
6252
6253 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6254 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6255 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6256 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6257 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6258
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006259 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006260
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006261 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6262
6263 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6264 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6265
6266 Example:
6267 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6268
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006269 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6270
6271 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6272 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6273
6274 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6275 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6276
6277 Example:
6278 - /#foo -> /
6279
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006280 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6281 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006282
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006283 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6284 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6285
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006286 Example:
6287 - /. -> /
6288 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6289 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6290 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006291
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006292 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6293 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6294
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006295 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006296 their preceding segment.
6297
6298 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6299 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6300
6301 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6302 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006303
6304 Example:
6305 - /foo/../ -> /
6306 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6307 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6308 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006309 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006310 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006311 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006312
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006313 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6314 removed as well:
6315
6316 Example:
6317 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6318 - /bar/../../ -> /
6319
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006320 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6321 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006322
6323 Example:
6324 - // -> /
6325 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6326
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006327 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6328 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6329
6330 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6331 ".", "_", and "~".
6332
6333 Example:
6334 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6335 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6336 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6337 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6338
6339 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6340 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6341
6342 Example:
6343 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6344 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6345
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006346 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006347 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006348
6349 Example:
6350 - /%6f -> /%6F
6351 - /%zz -> /%zz
6352
6353 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6354 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6355
6356 Example:
6357 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6358
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006359 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006360 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6361 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6362
6363 Example:
6364 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6365 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6366 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006368http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006369
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006370 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6371 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6372 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6373 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6374 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006376http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006378 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6379 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6380 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6381 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006383http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6384 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006385
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006386 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006387 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6388 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6389 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6390 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6391 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006392
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006393 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6394 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6395 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6396 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6397 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006398
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006399 Example:
6400 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6401
6402 # applied to:
6403 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6404
6405 # outputs:
6406 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6407
6408 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006409
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006410 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6411
6412 # applied to:
6413 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006414
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006415 # outputs:
6416 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006417
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006418http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6419 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6420
6421 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6422 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006423 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6424 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6425 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006426
6427 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6428 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6429 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6430
6431 Example:
6432 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6433 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6434
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006435 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6436 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6437 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6438 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6439
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006440http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6441 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6442
6443 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6444 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6445 query-string are replaced.
6446
6447 Example:
6448 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6449 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6450
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006451http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6452 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6453
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006454 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6455 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6456 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6457 against.
6458
6459 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6460 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6461 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006462
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006463 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6464 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6465 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6466 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6467 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6468 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6469 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6470 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6471 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006472 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6473 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006474
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006475 Example:
6476 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6477 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006478
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006479 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6480 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006482http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6483 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006484
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006485 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6486 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6487 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6488 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006489
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006490 Example:
6491 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006492
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006493 # applied to:
6494 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006495
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006496 # outputs:
6497 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006498
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006499http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6500 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6501 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006502 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006503 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6504
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006505 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006506 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6507 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006508 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006509 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006510 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006511 are followed to create the response :
6512
6513 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6514 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6515 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6516 ignored.
6517
6518 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6519 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006520 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006521 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6522 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006523
6524 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6525 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6526 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006527 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006528 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006529
6530 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6531 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6532 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006533 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006534 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006535 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006536
6537 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6538 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6539 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6540 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6541 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6542 as a raw content.
6543
6544 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6545 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6546 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6547 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6548 considered as a raw string.
6549
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006550 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006551 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6552 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6553 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6554
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006555 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6556 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006557 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006558
6559 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6560
6561 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006562 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006563 if { path /ping }
6564
6565 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6566 if { path /favicon.ico }
6567
6568 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6569 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6570 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006572http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6573http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006575 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6576 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6577 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006578
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006579http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6580 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006581
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006582 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6583 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6584 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6585 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006587http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006589 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6590 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6591 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6592 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6593 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006595 Arguments:
6596 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6597 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006599 Example:
6600 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6601 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006603 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6604 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006606http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006608 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6609 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6610 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006612 Arguments:
6613 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6614 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006616 Example:
6617 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6618 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006620 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6621 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6622 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006624http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006626 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6627 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6628 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6629 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6630 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006632 Example:
6633 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6634 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6635 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6636 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6637 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6638 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6639 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6640 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6641 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006643http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006645 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6646 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6647 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6648 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6649 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006651http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6652 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006654 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6655 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6656 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6657 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6658 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6659 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6660 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6661 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6662 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006664http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006666 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6667 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6668 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6669 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6670 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6671 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6672 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006674http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006676 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6677 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6678 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006680http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006682 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6683 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6684 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6685 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6686 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6687 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6688 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6689 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006691http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006693 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6694 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6695 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6696 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6697 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6698 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006700 Example :
6701 # prepend the host name before the path
6702 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006703
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006704http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6705
6706 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6707 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6708 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6709
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006710http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006712 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6713 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6714 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6715 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6716 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006718http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6721 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6722 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6723 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6724 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6725 values have higher priority.
6726 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6727 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6728 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6729 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6730 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006731
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006732http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006734 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6735 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6736 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6737 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6738 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6739 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6740 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006742 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006743
6744 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006745 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6746 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006748http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6749 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6750 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6751 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006752 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6753 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006754
6755 Arguments :
6756 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6757 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006758
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006759 See also "option forwardfor".
6760
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006761 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006762 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6763 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6764
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006765 # After the masking this will track connections
6766 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6767 http-request track-sc0 src
6768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006769 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6770 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6771
6772http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6773
6774 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6775 expression.
6776
6777 Arguments:
6778 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6779 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006780
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006781 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006782 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6783 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6784
6785 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6786 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6787 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6788
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006789http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006790 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6791
6792 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6793 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6794 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6795 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6796 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6797
6798 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6799 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6800 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6801 results.
6802
6803 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006804 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6805 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006807http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6808
6809 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6810 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6811 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6812 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6813 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6814 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6815 information from the request.
6816
6817 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6818
6819http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6820
6821 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6822 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet33c26132022-12-02 15:22:28 +01006823 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6824 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6825 path and the query string.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006826 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6827
6828http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6829
6830 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6831 inline.
6832
6833 Arguments:
6834 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6835 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6836 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6837 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6838 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6839 (request and response)
6840 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6841 processing
6842 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6843 processing
6844 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6845 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6846 and '_'.
6847
6848 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6849 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006850
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006851 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006852 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006854http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6855 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006856
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006857 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6858 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6859 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6860 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6861 agent name must be used.
6862
6863 Arguments:
6864 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6865
6866 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6867 configuration.
6868
6869http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6870
6871 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6872 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6873 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6874 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6875 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6876 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6877 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6878 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6879 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6880 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6881 action.
6882 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6883 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6884 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6885 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6886 you fully understand how it works.
6887
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006888http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6889
6890 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6891 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6892 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6893 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6894 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006895 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006896 processing.
6897
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006898 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006899 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6900 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6901 rules evaluation.
6902
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006903http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6904http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6905 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6906 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6907 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6908 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006909
6910 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6911 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6912 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006913 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6914 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6915 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6916 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6917 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6918 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006919 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006920 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6921 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6922 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006923 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006924 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6925 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6926 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6927 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6928 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006929
6930http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6931http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6932http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6933
6934 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6935 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6936 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6937 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006938 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006939 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6940 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6941 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6942 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6943 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6944 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6945 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6946
6947 Arguments :
6948 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6949 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6950 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6951 select which table entry to update the counters.
6952
6953 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6954 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6955 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6956 that table until the session ends.
6957
6958 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6959 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6960 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6961 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6962 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6963 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6964 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6965 useful information.
6966
6967 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6968 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6969 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6970 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6971 checks that make use of it.
6972
6973http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6974
6975 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006976
6977 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006978 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006979
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006980http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6981
6982 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6983 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6984 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6985 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6986 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6987 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6988
6989 Arguments :
6990 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6991
6992 Example:
6993 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6994
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006995http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6996 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6997
6998 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6999 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7000 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7001 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7002 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7003 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7004 http-buffer-request".
7005
7006 Arguments :
7007
7008 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7009 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7010
7011 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007012 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007013 bytes.
7014
7015 Example:
7016 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7017
7018 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007020http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007022 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7023 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7024 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007025
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007027http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007028 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7029
7030 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7031 no | yes | yes | yes
7032
7033 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7034 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7035 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7036 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7037 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7038 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7039
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007040 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7041 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007042
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007043 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007045 Example:
7046 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007048 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007050 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7051 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007052
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007053 Example:
7054 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007056 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007058 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7059 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007061 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7062 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007064http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007065
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007066 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7067 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7068 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7069 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7070 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7071 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7072 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7073 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007075http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007076
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007077 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7078 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7079 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7080 example, or to pass some internal information.
7081 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7082 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7083 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007085http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007087 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7088 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007089
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007090http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007091
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007092 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007094http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007096 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7097 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7098 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7099 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7100 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7101 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7102 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007103
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007104 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7105 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7106 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7107 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7108 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007109
7110 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7111 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7112 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7113 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007114
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007115http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007116
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007117 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7118 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7119 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7120 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7121 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7122 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007123
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007124http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007125
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007126 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7127 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7128 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7129 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7130 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007131
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007132http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007133
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007134 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7135 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7136 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7137 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7138 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7139 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007140
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007141http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7142http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7143 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7144 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7145 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7146 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007147
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007148 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7149 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7150 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007151 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007152 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7153 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7154 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007155 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007156 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007157
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007158http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007160 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7161 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7162 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7163 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7164 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7165 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007167http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7168 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007169
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007170 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7171 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007173 Example:
7174 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007175
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007176 # applied to:
7177 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007179 # outputs:
7180 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007181
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007182 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007184http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7185 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007186
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007187 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007188 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007189
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007190 Example:
7191 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007193 # applied to:
7194 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007196 # outputs:
7197 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007198
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007199http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7200 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7201 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007202 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007203 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7204
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007205 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007206 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7207 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007208 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007209 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007210 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007211 are followed to create the response :
7212
7213 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7214 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7215 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7216 ignored.
7217
7218 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7219 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007220 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007221 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7222 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007223
7224 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7225 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7226 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007227 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007228 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007229
7230 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7231 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7232 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007233 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007234 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007235 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007236
7237 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7238 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7239 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7240 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7241 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7242 as a raw content.
7243
7244 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7245 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7246 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7247 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7248 considered as a raw string.
7249
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007250 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7251 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7252 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7253 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7254
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007255 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7256 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007257 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007258
7259 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7260
7261 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007262 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007263 if { status eq 404 }
7264
7265 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7266 string "This is the end !" \
7267 if { status eq 500 }
7268
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007269http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7270http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007271
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007272 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7273 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7274 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007275
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007276http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7277 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007278
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007279 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7280 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7281 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7282 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007283
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007284http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7285 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007286
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007287 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7288 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7289 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7290 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7291 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007292
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007293 Arguments:
7294 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007295
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007296 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7297 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007298
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007299http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007300
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007301 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7302 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7303 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007304
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007305http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7306
7307 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7308 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7309 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7310 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7311 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7312
7313http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7314
7315 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7316 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7317 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7318 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7319 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7320 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7321 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7322 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7323 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7324
7325http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7326
7327 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7328 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7329 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7330 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7331 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7332 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7333 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7334
7335http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7336
7337 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7338 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7339 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7340 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7341 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7342 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7343 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7344 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7345
7346http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7347 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7348
7349 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7350 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7351 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7352 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007353
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007354 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007355 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7356 http-response set-status 431
7357 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7358 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007359
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007360http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007361
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007362 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7363 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7364 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7365 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7366 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7367 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7368 based on some information from the request.
7369
7370 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7371
7372http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7373
7374 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7375 inline.
7376
7377 Arguments:
7378 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7379 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7380 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7381 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7382 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7383 (request and response)
7384 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7385 processing
7386 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7387 processing
7388 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7389 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7390 and '_'.
7391
7392 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7393 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007394
7395 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007396 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007397
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007398http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007399
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007400 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7401 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7402 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7403 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7404 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7405 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7406 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7407 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7408 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7409 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7410 action.
7411 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7412 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7413 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7414 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7415 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007416
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007417http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7418
7419 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7420 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7421 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7422 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7423 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007424 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007425 processing.
7426
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007427 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007428 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007429 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007430 rules evaluation.
7431
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007432http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7433http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7434http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007435
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007436 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7437 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7438 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7439 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7440 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007441 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007442
7443http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7444
7445 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7446 about <var-name>.
7447
7448 Example:
7449 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7450
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007451http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7452 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7453
7454 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7455 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7456 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7457 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7458 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7459 buffer is full.
7460
7461 Arguments :
7462
7463 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7464 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7465
7466 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007467 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007468 bytes.
7469
7470 Example:
7471 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007472
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007473http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7474 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7475
7476 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7477 yes | no | yes | yes
7478
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007479 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007480 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7481 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7482 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007483
7484 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7485
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007486 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7487 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7488 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7489 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7490 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7491 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7492 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007493 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007494 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7495 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007496
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007497 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7498 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7499 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7500 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7501 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7502 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7503 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007504 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7505 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7506 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7507 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7508 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7509 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007510
7511 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7512 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7513 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7514 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7515 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7516 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7517 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7518 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007519 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007520 downsides of rare connection failures.
7521
7522 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7523 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7524 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7525 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7526 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7527 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007528 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007529 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7530 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7531 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7532 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7533 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7534
7535 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007536 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7537 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7538 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7539 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007540
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007541 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7542 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007543
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007544 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007545
7546 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7547 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7548 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7549
Willy Tarreauee9afa22022-11-25 09:17:18 +01007550 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
7551 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
7552 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
7553 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
7554 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
7555 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
7556 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
7557 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
7558 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
7559 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
7560 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
7561
7562 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
7563 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
7564 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
7565 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
7566 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
7567
7568 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
7569 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007570
7571
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007572http-send-name-header [<header>]
7573 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7575 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007576 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007577 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7578
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007579 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7580 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7581 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7582 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7583 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7584 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7585 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7586 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7587 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7588 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7589 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7590 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7591 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7592 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7593 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7594 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007595
7596 See also : "server"
7597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007598id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007599 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7601 no | yes | yes | yes
7602 Arguments : none
7603
7604 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7605 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7606 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007607
7608
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007609ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7610 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007612 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007613
7614 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7615 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7616 and running).
7617
7618 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7619 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7620 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007621 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007622 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7623
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007624 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7625 "unless" condition is met.
7626
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007627 Example:
7628 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7629 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7630 ignore-persist if url_static
7631
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007632 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7633
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007634load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7635 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7636 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7637 yes | no | yes | yes
7638
7639 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7640 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7641 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007642 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007643 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007644 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7645 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7646 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7647
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007648 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007649 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007650 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007651
7652 Arguments:
7653 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7654 named "server-state-file".
7655
7656 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7657 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7658 name is used as a file name.
7659
7660 none don't load any stat for this backend
7661
7662 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007663 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7664 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7665 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007666 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007667 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007668
7669 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7670 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7671
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007672 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007673
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007674 global
7675 stats socket /tmp/socket
7676 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007677
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007678 defaults
7679 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007680
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007681 backend bk
7682 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7683 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007684
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007685
7686 Then one can run :
7687
7688 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7689
7690 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7691
7692 1
7693 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7694 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7695 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7696
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007697 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007698
7699 global
7700 stats socket /tmp/socket
7701 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7702
7703 defaults
7704 load-server-state-from-file local
7705
7706 backend bk
7707 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7708 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7709
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007710
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007711 Then one can run :
7712
7713 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7714
7715 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7716
7717 1
7718 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7719 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7720 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7721
7722 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7723 "show servers state"
7724
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007725
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007726log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007727log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007728 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007729no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007730 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7732 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007733
7734 Prefix :
7735 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7736 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7737 prefix does not allow arguments.
7738
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007739 Arguments :
7740 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7741 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7742 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7743 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7744 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7745 parameter.
7746
7747 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7748 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7749
7750 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7751 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7752 standard syslog port).
7753
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007754 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7755 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7756 standard syslog port).
7757
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007758 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7759 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7760 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007761 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007762
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007763 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7764 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7765 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7766 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7767 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7768 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7769 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7770 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7771 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7772 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7773 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7774 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007775 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007776 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7777 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7778 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007779 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7780 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007781
7782 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7783 and "fd@2", see above.
7784
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007785 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7786 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7787 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7788 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7789 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7790 having the logs instantly available.
7791
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007792 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7793 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7794 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7795
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007796 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7797 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007798
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007799 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7800 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7801 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7802 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7803 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7804 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7805 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7806 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7807 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7808 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007809 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007810
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007811 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7812 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7813 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7814 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7815 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7816
7817 <sample_size>
7818 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7819 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7820 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7821 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7822 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7823
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007824 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7825 one of the following :
7826
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007827 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7828 field is stripped. This is the default.
7829 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7830 rfc3164.
7831
7832 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007833 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7834
7835 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7836 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7837
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007838 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7839 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7840 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7841 designed to be used with a local log server.
7842
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007843 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7844 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7845 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7846 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7847 systemd logger consumes.
7848
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007849 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7850 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7851 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7852 used with a local log server.
7853
7854 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7855 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7856 designed to be used with a local log server.
7857
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007858 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7859 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7860 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7861 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7862
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007863 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7864
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007865 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7866 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7867 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7868
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007869 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7870 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7871 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7872 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007873
7874 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7875 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7876 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007877 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7878 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7879 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7880 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7881 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007882
7883 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7884
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007885 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7886 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7887 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007888
7889 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7890 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7891 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7892 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7893
7894 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7895 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007896
7897 Example :
7898 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007899 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7900 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7901 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007902 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007903 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7904 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007905 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007906
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007907
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007908log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007909 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7910 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7911 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007912
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007913 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7914 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7915 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7916 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7917 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007918
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007919 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7920 "option httplog" directives.
7921
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007922log-format-sd <string>
7923 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7925 yes | yes | yes | no
7926
7927 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7928 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7929 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7930 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7931 which covers the log format string in depth.
7932
7933 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7934 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7935
7936 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7937 log format to "rfc5424".
7938
7939 Example :
7940 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7941
7942
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007943log-tag <string>
7944 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7945 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7946 yes | yes | yes | yes
7947
7948 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7949 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007950 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007951 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7952 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7953 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7954 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7955 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7956 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007957
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007958max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7959 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7960 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7961 yes | no | yes | yes
7962
7963 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7964 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7965 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7966 servers.
7967
7968 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007969 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007970 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7971 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7972 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007973 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007974 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7975 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7976 picking a different server.
7977
7978 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7979 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7980 even if they have to be queued.
7981
7982 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7983 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7984
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007985max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7986 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7987 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7988 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007990maxconn <conns>
7991 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7993 yes | yes | yes | no
7994 Arguments :
7995 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7996 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7997 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7998 closes.
7999
8000 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008001 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008002 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8003 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008004 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8005 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8006 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8007 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008008
8009 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8010 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8011 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8012
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008013 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8014 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008015
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008016 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8017
8018
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008019mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008020 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8022 yes | yes | yes | yes
8023 Arguments :
8024 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8025 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8026 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8027 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8028
8029 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8030 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8031 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8032 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8033 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8034
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008035 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8036 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8037 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008038
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008039 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008040 defaults http_instances
8041 mode http
8042
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008043
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008044monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008045 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8047 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008048 Arguments :
8049 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8050 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008051 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008052 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8053 backend and its backup.
8054
8055 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8056 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8057 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8058 servers in a list of backends.
8059
8060 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8061 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8062 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008063 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008064 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8065 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008066 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008067 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8068 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008069
8070 Example:
8071 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008072 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008073 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8074 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8075 monitor-uri /site_alive
8076 monitor fail if site_dead
8077
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008078 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008079
8080
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008081monitor-uri <uri>
8082 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8084 yes | yes | yes | no
8085 Arguments :
8086 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8087 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8088
8089 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8090 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8091 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8092 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8093 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8094 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8095 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8096 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8097
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008098 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008099 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8100 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8101 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8102 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8103 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8104 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008105
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008106 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8107 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8108 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8109 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8110
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008111 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008112 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008113 frontend www
8114 mode http
8115 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8116
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008117 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008118
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008119
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008120option abortonclose
8121no option abortonclose
8122 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8124 yes | no | yes | yes
8125 Arguments : none
8126
8127 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8128 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8129 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8130 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008131 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008132 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8133 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8134 encountered while delivering the response.
8135
8136 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8137 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8138 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8139 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8140 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8141 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008142 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008143 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008144 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008145 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8146 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8147 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8148
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008149 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8150 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008151 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8152 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8153 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8154 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8155 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8156 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008157 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008158
8159 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8160 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8161
8162 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8163
8164
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008165option accept-invalid-http-request
8166no option accept-invalid-http-request
8167 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8169 yes | yes | yes | no
8170 Arguments : none
8171
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008172 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008173 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008174 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008175 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8176 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8177 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8178 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8179 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008180 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8181 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8182 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8183 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008184 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008185 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008186 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8187 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8188 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008189
8190 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8191 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8192 been confirmed.
8193
8194 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8195 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008196 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8197 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008198 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8199
8200 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8201 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8202
8203 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8204 stats socket.
8205
8206
8207option accept-invalid-http-response
8208no option accept-invalid-http-response
8209 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8211 yes | no | yes | yes
8212 Arguments : none
8213
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008214 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008215 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008216 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008217 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8218 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8219 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8220 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8221 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008222 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8223 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8224 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008225
8226 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8227 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8228 been confirmed.
8229
8230 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8231 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8232 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8233 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8234
8235 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8236 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8237
8238 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8239 stats socket.
8240
8241
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008242option allbackups
8243no option allbackups
8244 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8246 yes | no | yes | yes
8247 Arguments : none
8248
8249 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8250 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8251 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8252 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8253 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8254 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8255 order between the backup servers anymore.
8256
8257 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8258 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8259
8260 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8261 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8262
8263
8264option checkcache
8265no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008266 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8268 yes | no | yes | yes
8269 Arguments : none
8270
8271 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8272 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008273 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008274 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8275 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008276 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008277
8278 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008279 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008280 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008281 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8282 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008283 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008284 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008285 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8286 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008287 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008288 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8289 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008290 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008291 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8292 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8293 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8294 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8295 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8296 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8297 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8298 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8299 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8300
8301 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008302 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8303 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8304 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8305 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008306
8307 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8308 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008309 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008310 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008311
8312 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8313 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8314
8315
8316option clitcpka
8317no option clitcpka
8318 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8320 yes | yes | yes | no
8321 Arguments : none
8322
8323 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8324 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008325 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008326 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8327
8328 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8329 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8330 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8331 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8332
8333 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8334 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8335 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8336 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8337 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8338
8339 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8340
8341 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8342 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8343 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8344
8345 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8346 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8347
8348 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8349
8350
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008351option contstats
8352 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8354 yes | yes | yes | no
8355 Arguments : none
8356
8357 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8358 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8359 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008360 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008361 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8362 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8363 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8364 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8365 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008366
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008367option disable-h2-upgrade
8368no option disable-h2-upgrade
8369 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8370 connection.
8371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8372 yes | yes | yes | no
8373 Arguments : none
8374
8375 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8376 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8377 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8378 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008379 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8380 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8381 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8382 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8383 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8384 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008385
8386 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8387 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008388
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008389option dontlog-normal
8390no option dontlog-normal
8391 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8393 yes | yes | yes | no
8394 Arguments : none
8395
8396 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8397 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8398 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8399 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8400 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8401 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8402 logged.
8403
8404 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8405 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8406 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008408 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008409 logging.
8410
8411
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008412option dontlognull
8413no option dontlognull
8414 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8416 yes | yes | yes | no
8417 Arguments : none
8418
8419 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8420 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8421 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8422 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8423 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8424 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008425 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8426 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8427 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008428
8429 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008430 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008431 would not be logged.
8432
8433 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8434 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8435
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008436 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008437 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008438
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008439
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008440option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008441 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8443 yes | yes | yes | yes
8444 Arguments :
8445 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8446 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008447 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008448 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008449
8450 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8451 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8452 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8453 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8454 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8455 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8456 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008457 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8458 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8459 possible that the client has already brought one.
8460
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008461 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008462 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008463 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008464 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008465 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008466 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008467
8468 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8469 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8470 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8471 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8472 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8473 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008474 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008475
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008476 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8477 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008478 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008479 are under the control of the end-user.
8480
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008481 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008482 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8483 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008484 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8485 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8486 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008487
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008488 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008489 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8490 frontend www
8491 mode http
8492 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8493
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008494 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8495 backend www
8496 mode http
8497 option forwardfor header X-Client
8498
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008499 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008500 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008501
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008502
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008503option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8504no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8505 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8507 yes | yes | yes | no
8508 Arguments : none
8509
8510 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8511 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8512 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8513 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8514 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8515 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8516 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8517
8518 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8519 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8520 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8521 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8522 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8523 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8524 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8525 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8526 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8527 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8528
8529 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8530
8531 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8532 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8533
8534 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8535 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8536
8537
8538option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8539no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8540 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8542 yes | no | yes | yes
8543 Arguments : none
8544
8545 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8546 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8547 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8548 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8549 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8550 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8551 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8552
8553 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8554 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8555 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8556 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8557 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8558 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8559 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8560 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8561 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8562 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8563
8564 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8565
8566 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8567 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8568
8569 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8570 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8571
8572
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008573option http-buffer-request
8574no option http-buffer-request
8575 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8577 yes | yes | yes | yes
8578 Arguments : none
8579
8580 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8581 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8582 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8583 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8584 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8585 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008586 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8587 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8588 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8589 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008590
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008591 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8592 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008593
8594
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008595option http-ignore-probes
8596no option http-ignore-probes
8597 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8599 yes | yes | yes | no
8600 Arguments : none
8601
8602 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8603 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8604 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8605 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8606 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8607 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8608 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8609 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8610 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008611 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8612 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008613 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8614
8615 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8616 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8617 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8618 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8619 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8620 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8621 are often the only way to detect them.
8622
8623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8625
8626 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8627
8628
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008629option http-keep-alive
8630no option http-keep-alive
8631 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8633 yes | yes | yes | yes
8634 Arguments : none
8635
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008636 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8637 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008638 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8639 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008640 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8641 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8642 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008643
8644 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8645 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008646 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8647 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8648 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8649 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8650 situations where this option may be useful :
8651
8652 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008653 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008654
8655 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8656 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8657
8658 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8659 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8660 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8661 request.
8662
8663 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8664 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008665 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8666 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8667 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008668
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008669 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8670 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8671 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8672 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8673 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8674 not set.
8675
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008676 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8677 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8678 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008679
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008680 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008681 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008682 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008683
8684
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008685option http-no-delay
8686no option http-no-delay
8687 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8689 yes | yes | yes | yes
8690 Arguments : none
8691
8692 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8693 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8694 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8695 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8696 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8697 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8698 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008699 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008700 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8701 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8702 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8703 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8704 affected.
8705
8706 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8707 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8708 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8709 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8710 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8711 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8712 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8713 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8714 latency environments.
8715
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008716 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8717
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008718
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008719option http-pretend-keepalive
8720no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008721 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008723 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008724 Arguments : none
8725
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008726 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008727 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8728 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8729 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008730 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008731 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8732 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8733 consider the response complete.
8734
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008735 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008736 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008737 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008738 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008739 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008740 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8741
8742 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8743 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8744 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8745 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008746 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8747 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008748 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8749
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008750 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8751 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8752 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8753 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8754 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8755 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008756
8757 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8758 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8759
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008760 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008761 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008762
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008763option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8764 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8765 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8767 yes | yes | yes | yes
8768 Arguments :
8769 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8770 with no FastCGI application configured.
8771
8772 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8773 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8774 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8775
8776 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8777 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8778
8779 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8780 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8781 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8782 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8783 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8784 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8785 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8786 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8787
8788 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8789 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008790
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008791option http-server-close
8792no option http-server-close
8793 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8795 yes | yes | yes | yes
8796 Arguments : none
8797
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008798 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8799 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8800 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8801 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008802 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8803 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8804 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8805 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8806 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8807 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8808 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8809 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8810 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8811 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8812 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008813
8814 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8815 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8816 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8817 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008818 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8819 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008820
8821 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8822 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008823 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8824 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8825 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008826
8827 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8828 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8829
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008830 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8831 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008832
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008833option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008834no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008835 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8837 yes | yes | yes | no
8838 Arguments : none
8839
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008840 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008841 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8842 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8843 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8844 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8845 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008846 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008847
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008848 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008849 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008850 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8851 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8852 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008853
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008854 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8855 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8856 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8857 front of an existing proxy.
8858
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008859 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8860
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008861 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008862
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008863option httpchk
8864option httpchk <uri>
8865option httpchk <method> <uri>
8866option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008867 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8869 yes | no | yes | yes
8870 Arguments :
8871 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8872 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8873 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8874 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8875 ones.
8876
8877 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8878 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8879 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8880
8881 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8882 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8883 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008884 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008885
8886 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8887 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8888 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8889 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8890 the lack of any response.
8891
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008892 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8893 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8894 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8895 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8896
8897 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8898 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8899 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008900
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008901 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8902 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008903 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008904 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008905 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008906
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008907 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8908 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8909 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8910 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8911
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008912 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008913 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8914 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8915 backend https_relay
8916 mode tcp
8917 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8918 http-check send hdr Host www
8919 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008920
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008921 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8922 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8923 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008924
8925
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008926option httpclose
8927no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008928 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8930 yes | yes | yes | yes
8931 Arguments : none
8932
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008933 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8934 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8935 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8936 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008937 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008938
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008939 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8940 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008941 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008942 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8943 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008944
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008945 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8946 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8947 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008948
8949 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8950 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008951 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8952 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8953 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008954
8955 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8956 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8957
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008958 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008959
8960
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008961option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008962 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008964 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008965 Arguments :
8966 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8967 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8968 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008969 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008970 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008971
8972 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8973 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8974 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8975 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8976 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8977 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8978 ports.
8979
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008980 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8981 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008982
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008983 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008985 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008986
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008987
8988option http_proxy
8989no option http_proxy
8990 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8992 yes | yes | yes | yes
8993 Arguments : none
8994
8995 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8996 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8997 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8998 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8999 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
9000
9001 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
9002 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009003 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
9004 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009005
9006 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9007 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9008
9009 Example :
9010 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
9011 backend direct_forward
9012 option httpclose
9013 option http_proxy
9014
9015 See also : "option httpclose"
9016
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009017
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009018option independent-streams
9019no option independent-streams
9020 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9022 yes | yes | yes | yes
9023 Arguments : none
9024
9025 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9026 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9027 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9028 receive data or not.
9029
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009030 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009031 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9032 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9033 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9034 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9035 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9036 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9037 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9038 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9039 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9040 socket buffers.
9041
9042 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9043 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9044 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9045 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9046 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9047
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009048 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009049
9050
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009051option ldap-check
9052 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9054 yes | no | yes | yes
9055 Arguments : none
9056
9057 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9058 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9059 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9060 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9061
9062 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9063 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9064
9065 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9066 configure it.
9067
9068 Example :
9069 option ldap-check
9070
9071 See also : "option httpchk"
9072
9073
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009074option external-check
9075 Use external processes for server health checks
9076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9077 yes | no | yes | yes
9078
9079 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9080 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9081 command".
9082
9083 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9084
9085 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9086
9087
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009088option idle-close-on-response
9089no option idle-close-on-response
9090 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9092 yes | yes | yes | no
9093 Arguments : none
9094
9095 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9096 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9097 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9098 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9099 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9100 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9101 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9102 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9103 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9104
9105 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9106 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9107
9108 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9109 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9110 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9111 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9112
9113 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9114 "hard-stop-after"
9115
9116
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009117option log-health-checks
9118no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009119 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9121 yes | no | yes | yes
9122 Arguments : none
9123
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009124 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9125 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9126 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009127
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009128 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9129 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9130 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9131 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9132 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009134 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009135 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009136
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009137 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9138 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9139 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009140
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009141
9142option log-separate-errors
9143no option log-separate-errors
9144 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9146 yes | yes | yes | no
9147 Arguments : none
9148
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009149 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009150 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9151 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9152 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9153 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9154 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9155 provides very important information.
9156
9157 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9158 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9159 error logs.
9160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009161 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009162 logging.
9163
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009164
9165option logasap
9166no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009167 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9169 yes | yes | yes | no
9170 Arguments : none
9171
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009172 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9173 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9174 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9175 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9176
9177 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9178 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9179 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9180 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9181 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009182 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009183 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9184 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9185 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9186 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009187 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009188
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009189 Examples :
9190 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9191 mode http
9192 option httplog
9193 option logasap
9194 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9195
9196 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9197 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9198 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9199 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009201 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009202 logging.
9203
9204
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009205option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009206 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9208 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009209 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009210 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9211 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009212 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9213 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009214
9215 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9216 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009217 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009218 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009219 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9220 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9221 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009222
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009223 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9224 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9225 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009226
9227 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009228 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009229 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9230 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9231 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9232 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9233 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9234 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9235 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9236
9237 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9238 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009239
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009240 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009241
9242 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9243 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9244 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9245 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009246 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009247 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009248
9249 See also: "option httpchk"
9250
9251
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009252option nolinger
9253no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009254 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009255 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9256 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009257 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009258
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009259 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009260 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9261 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9262 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9263 connections.
9264
9265 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9266 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009267 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9268 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9269 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9270 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9271 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9272 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9273 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9274 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9275 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9276 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9277 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9278 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9279 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009280
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009281 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9282 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9283 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9284 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9285 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009286
9287 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9288 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009289 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009290 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009291 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009292
9293 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9294 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9295
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009296 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9297 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009298
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009299option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9300 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9302 yes | yes | yes | yes
9303 Arguments :
9304 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9305 matching <network>
9306 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9307 header name.
9308
9309 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9310 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9311 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9312 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9313 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9314 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9315 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9316 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9317 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9318 possible that the client has already brought one.
9319
9320 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9321 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9322 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9323 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9324 header and requires different one.
9325
9326 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9327 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9328 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009329 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9330 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9331 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9332 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9333 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009334
9335 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9336 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9337 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9338 both are defined.
9339
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009340 Examples :
9341 # Original Destination address
9342 frontend www
9343 mode http
9344 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9345
9346 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9347 backend www
9348 mode http
9349 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9350
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009351 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009352
9353
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009354option persist
9355no option persist
9356 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9357 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9358 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009359 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009360
9361 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9362 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9363 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9364 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9365 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9366 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9367 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9368 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9369 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9370 redirected to another valid server.
9371
9372 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9373 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9374
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009375 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009376
9377
Christopher Faulet36136e52022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009378option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009379 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9381 yes | no | yes | yes
9382 Arguments :
9383 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9384 PostgreSQL server.
9385
9386 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9387 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9388 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9389 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9390
9391 See also: "option httpchk"
9392
9393
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009394option prefer-last-server
9395no option prefer-last-server
9396 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9397 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9398 yes | no | yes | yes
9399 Arguments : none
9400
9401 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009402 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009403 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9404 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009405 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009406 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009407 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009408 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9409 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009410 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009411 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009412 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9413 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9414 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009415 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9416 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9417 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009418
9419 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9420 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9421
9422 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9423
9424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009425option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009426option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009427no option redispatch
9428 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9429 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9430 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009431 Arguments :
9432 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9433 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9434 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009435 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009436 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009437 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009438 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9439 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9440 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9441
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009442
9443 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9444 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9445 be able to access the service anymore.
9446
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009447 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9448 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009449
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009450 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9451 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9452 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9453 following order:
9454
9455 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9456
9457 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9458 list, or
9459
9460 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9461
9462 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9463 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9464
9465 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9466 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9467 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9468 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9469
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009470 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009471 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9472 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009473
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009474 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9475 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9476
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009477 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009478
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009479
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009480option redis-check
9481 Use redis health checks for server testing
9482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9483 yes | no | yes | yes
9484 Arguments : none
9485
9486 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9487 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9488 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9489 find the "+PONG" response message.
9490
9491 Example :
9492 option redis-check
9493
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009494 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009495
9496
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009497option smtpchk
9498option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9499 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9501 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009502 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009503 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009504 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009505 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9506
9507 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9508 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9509 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9510
9511 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9512 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9513 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9514 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9515 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9516 dead server.
9517
9518 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9519 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009520 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009521 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9522
9523 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9524 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9525 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9526 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009527 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009528
9529 Example :
9530 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9531
9532 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9533
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009535option socket-stats
9536no option socket-stats
9537
9538 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9540 yes | yes | yes | no
9541
9542 Arguments : none
9543
9544
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009545option splice-auto
9546no option splice-auto
9547 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9549 yes | yes | yes | yes
9550 Arguments : none
9551
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009552 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009553 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009554 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009555 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009556 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009557 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9558 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9559 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9560 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9561
9562 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9563 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9564 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9565 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9566 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9567 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9568 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9569 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9570 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9571 keyword.
9572
9573 Example :
9574 option splice-auto
9575
9576 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9577 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9578
9579 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9580 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9581
9582
9583option splice-request
9584no option splice-request
9585 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9587 yes | yes | yes | yes
9588 Arguments : none
9589
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009590 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009591 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009592 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9593 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9594 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9595 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9596
9597 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9598
9599 Example :
9600 option splice-request
9601
9602 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9603 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9604
9605 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9606 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9607
9608
9609option splice-response
9610no option splice-response
9611 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9613 yes | yes | yes | yes
9614 Arguments : none
9615
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009616 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009617 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009618 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9619 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9620 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9621 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9622
9623 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9624
9625 Example :
9626 option splice-response
9627
9628 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9629 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9630
9631 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9632 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9633
9634
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009635option spop-check
9636 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9638 no | no | no | yes
9639 Arguments : none
9640
9641 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9642 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9643 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9644 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9645
9646 Example :
9647 option spop-check
9648
9649 See also : "option httpchk"
9650
9651
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009652option srvtcpka
9653no option srvtcpka
9654 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9656 yes | no | yes | yes
9657 Arguments : none
9658
9659 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9660 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009661 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009662 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9663
9664 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9665 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9666 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9667 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9668
9669 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9670 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9671 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9672 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9673 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9674
9675 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9676
9677 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9678 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9679 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9680
9681 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9682 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9683
9684 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9685
9686
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009687option ssl-hello-chk
9688 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9690 yes | no | yes | yes
9691 Arguments : none
9692
9693 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9694 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9695 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9696 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9697 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9698 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9699 hello message.
9700
9701 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9702 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9703 messages, which is appreciable.
9704
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009705 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009706 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9707 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009708
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009709 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9710
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009711
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009712option tcp-check
9713 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9714 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9715 yes | no | yes | yes
9716
9717 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9718 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9719
9720 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9721 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9722 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9723
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009724 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009725 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9726 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9727 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9728 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9729 only.
9730
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009731 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009732 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009733 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9734 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9735 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9736
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009737 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009738 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9739 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009740 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009741 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9742 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9743 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9744 the respective protocols.
9745 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009746 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009747
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009748 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009749
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009750 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9751 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9752 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9753 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009754
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009755 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9756 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9757 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009758
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009759
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009760 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009761 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009762 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009763 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009764
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009765 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009766 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009767 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009768
9769 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9770 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009771 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009772 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009773 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009774 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009775 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009776 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009777 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9778 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009779 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009780 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9781 tcp-check expect string +OK
9782
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009783 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009784 (send many headers before analyzing)
9785 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009786 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009787 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9788 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9789 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9790 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009791 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009792
9793
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009794 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009795
9796
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009797option tcp-smart-accept
9798no option tcp-smart-accept
9799 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9801 yes | yes | yes | no
9802 Arguments : none
9803
9804 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9805 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9806 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9807 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9808 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9809 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9810
9811 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9812 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9813 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9814 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9815
9816 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9817 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9818 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009819 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009820
9821 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9822 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9823 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9824
9825 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9826 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9827 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9828
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009829 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9830
9831
9832option tcp-smart-connect
9833no option tcp-smart-connect
9834 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9836 yes | no | yes | yes
9837 Arguments : none
9838
9839 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9840 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9841 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9842 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9843 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9844
9845 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9846 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9847 complex.
9848
9849 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9850 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9851 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9852
9853 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9854 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9855
9856 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9857
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009858
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009859option tcpka
9860 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9862 yes | yes | yes | yes
9863 Arguments : none
9864
9865 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9866 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009867 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009868 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9869
9870 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9871 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9872 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9873 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9874
9875 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9876 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9877 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9878 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9879 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9880
9881 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9882
9883 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9884 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9885 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9886 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9887 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9888 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9889 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9890 backends.
9891
9892 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9893
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009894
9895option tcplog
9896 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009898 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009899 Arguments : none
9900
9901 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9902 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9903 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9904 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9905 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9906 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9907 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9908 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9909
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009910 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009912 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009913
9914
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009915option transparent
9916no option transparent
9917 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009919 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009920 Arguments : none
9921
9922 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9923 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9924 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9925 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9926 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9927 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9928 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9929 appropriate server.
9930
9931 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9932 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9933
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009934 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009935 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009936
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009937
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009938external-check command <command>
9939 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9941 yes | no | yes | yes
9942
9943 Arguments :
9944 <command> is the external command to run
9945
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009946 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9947
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009948 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009949
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009950 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9951 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9952 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9953 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9954 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9955 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009956
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009957 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9958
9959 Environment variables :
9960 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9961 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9962
9963 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9964
9965 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9966
9967 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9968 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9969 for a UNIX socket).
9970
9971 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9972
9973 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9974
9975 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9976
9977 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9978
9979 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9980
9981 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9982 socket).
9983
9984 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9985 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9986
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009987 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9988
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009989 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9990 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9991 failed.
9992
9993 Example :
9994 external-check command /bin/true
9995
9996 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9997
9998
9999external-check path <path>
10000 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10002 yes | no | yes | yes
10003
10004 Arguments :
10005 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10006
10007 The default path is "".
10008
10009 Example :
10010 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10011
10012 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10013 "external-check command"
10014
10015
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010016persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010017persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010018 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10020 yes | no | yes | yes
10021 Arguments :
10022 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010023 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10024 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010025
10026 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10027 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010028 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010029 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10030 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10031 forwarded to this server.
10032
10033 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10034 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10035 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010036 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010037 a single "listen" section.
10038
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010039 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10040 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10041 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10042
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010043 Example :
10044 listen tse-farm
10045 bind :3389
10046 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10047 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10048 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10049 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10050 persist rdp-cookie
10051 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010052 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010053 balance rdp-cookie
10054 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10055 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10056
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010057 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010058
10059
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010060rate-limit sessions <rate>
10061 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10063 yes | yes | yes | no
10064 Arguments :
10065 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10066 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10067
10068 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10069 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10070 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010071 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010072 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10073 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10074
10075 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10076 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10077 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10078 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10079
10080 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10081 listen smtp
10082 mode tcp
10083 bind :25
10084 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010085 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010086
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010087 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10088 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10089 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010090
10091 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10092
10093
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010094redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10095redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10096redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010097 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10099 no | yes | yes | yes
10100
10101 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010102 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010103
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010104 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010105 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010106 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10107 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10108 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010109
10110 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10111 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10112 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10113 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10114 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010115 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10116 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10117 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10118 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010119
10120 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10121 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10122 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10123 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10124 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10125 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010126 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010127 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010128 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10129 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10130 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010131
10132 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010133 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10134 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10135 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010136 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010137 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10138 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10139 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10140 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010141
10142 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010143 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010144
10145 - "drop-query"
10146 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10147 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10148 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10149 with a location-type redirect.
10150
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010151 - "append-slash"
10152 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10153 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10154 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10155 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10156
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010157 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10158 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10159 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10160 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10161 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10162 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10163 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10164
10165 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10166 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10167 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10168 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10169 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10170 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10171 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010172
10173 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10174 acl clear dst_port 80
10175 acl secure dst_port 8080
10176 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010177 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010178 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010179 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10180
10181 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010182 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10183 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10184 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010185 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010186
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010187 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10188 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10189 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10190
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010191 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010192 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010193
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010194 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010195 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10196 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10197 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010199 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010200
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010201
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010202retries <value>
10203 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10204 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10205 yes | no | yes | yes
10206 Arguments :
10207 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10208 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10209 default value is 3.
10210
10211 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10212 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10213 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10214
10215 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010216 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10217 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010218
10219 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10220 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10221
10222 See also : "option redispatch"
10223
10224
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010225retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010226 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10227 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10228 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010229 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10230 yes | no | yes | yes
10231 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010232 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10233 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10234 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10235 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10236 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010237
10238 none never retry
10239
10240 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10241 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10242
10243 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10244 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10245 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10246 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10247 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10248 processing the request.
10249
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010250 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10251 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10252 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10253 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10254 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10255 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10256 overflow attack for example).
10257
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010258 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10259 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10260 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10261 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10262 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10263 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10264 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10265 amplify denial of service attacks.
10266
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010267 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10268 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10269 considered to be safe to retry.
10270
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010271 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10272 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10273 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10274 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10275 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010276
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010277 all-retryable-errors
10278 retry request for any error that are considered
10279 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10280 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10281 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10282
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010283 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10284 not cumulative.
10285
10286 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10287 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10288 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10289 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10290
10291 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10292 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10293 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10294 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10295 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10296 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10297 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10298 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10299 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10300 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10301 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10302 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10303
10304 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10305 should not use this directive.
10306
10307 The default is "conn-failure".
10308
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010309 Example:
10310 retry-on 503 504
10311
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010312 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10313
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010314server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010315 Declare a server in a backend
10316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10317 no | no | yes | yes
10318 Arguments :
10319 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010320 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010321 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010322
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010323 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10324 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10325 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10326 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010327 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10328 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010329 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010330 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10331 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010332 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10333 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10334 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10335 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10336 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10337 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10338 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010339 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010340 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10341 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10342 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10343 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10344 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10345 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010346 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10347 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010348 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10349 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010350
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010351 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010352 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10353 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10354 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10355 adding this value to the client's port.
10356
10357 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10358 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010359 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010360
10361 Examples :
10362 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10363 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010364 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010365 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10366 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10367 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010368
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010369 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10370 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10371 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10372 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10373 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10374
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010375 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10376 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010377
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010378server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010379 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010380 this backend.
10381 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10382 no | no | yes | yes
10383
10384 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10385 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10386 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10387 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10388 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010389
10390 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10391 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10392
10393 global
10394 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10395
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010396 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010397 load-server-state-from-file
10398
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010399 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010400 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010401
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010402server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10403 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10404 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10406 no | no | yes | yes
10407
10408 Arguments:
10409 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10410
10411 <num | range>
10412 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10413 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10414 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10415 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10416
10417 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10418
10419 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10420
10421 <params*>
10422 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10423 keyword.
10424
10425 Examples:
10426 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10427 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10428 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10429
10430 # or
10431 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10432
10433 # would be equivalent to:
10434 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10435 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10436 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10437
10438
10439
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010440source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010441source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010442source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010443 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10445 yes | no | yes | yes
10446 Arguments :
10447 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10448 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010449
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010450 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010451 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10452 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10453 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10454 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10455 supported prefixes are :
10456 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10457 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10458 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010459 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010460 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10461 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010462
10463 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10464 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010465 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10466 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10467 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010468
10469 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10470 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10471 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10472 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10473 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10474 <addr>.
10475
10476 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10477 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10478 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10479 port.
10480
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010481 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10482 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10483 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10484 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010485 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010486 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10487 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10488 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10489 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10490 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10491 HTTP header.
10492
10493 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10494 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010495 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010496 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10497 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10498 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10499 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10500 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10501 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10502 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10503
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010504 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10505 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10506 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10507 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10508 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10509 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10510
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010511 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10512 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10513 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10514 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10515
10516 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10517 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10518 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10519 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10520 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10521 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10522
10523 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10524 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10525 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10526 there are two methods :
10527
10528 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10529 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10530 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10531 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10532 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10533 of the client ranges may be used.
10534
10535 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10536 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10537 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10538 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10539 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10540 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10541 same session.
10542
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010543 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10544 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10545 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010546 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010547
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010548 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10549
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010550 Examples :
10551 backend private
10552 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10553 source 192.168.1.200
10554
10555 backend transparent_ssl1
10556 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10557 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10558
10559 backend transparent_ssl2
10560 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10561 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10562 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10563
10564 backend transparent_ssl3
10565 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10566 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10567 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10568
10569 backend transparent_smtp
10570 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10571 # with Tproxy version 4.
10572 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10573
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010574 backend transparent_http
10575 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10576 # proxy.
10577 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10578
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010579 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010580 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10581
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010582
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010583srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10584 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10585 the connection on the server side.
10586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10587 yes | no | yes | yes
10588 Arguments :
10589 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10590
10591 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10592 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010593 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10594 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010595
10596 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10597
10598
10599srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10600 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10601 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10602 server side.
10603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10604 yes | no | yes | yes
10605 Arguments :
10606 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10607 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10608 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10609 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10610
10611 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10612 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010613 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10614 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010615
10616 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10617
10618
10619srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10620 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10622 yes | no | yes | yes
10623 Arguments :
10624 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10625 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10626 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10627 document.
10628
10629 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10630 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010631 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10632 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010633
10634 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10635
10636
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010637stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10638 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010640 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010641
10642 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10643 matched.
10644
10645 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10646 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10647
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010648 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10649 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010650 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010651
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010652 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10653 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10654 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10655 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010656
10657 Example :
10658 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10659 backend stats_localhost
10660 stats enable
10661 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10662
10663 Example :
10664 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10665 backend stats_auth
10666 stats enable
10667 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10668 stats admin if TRUE
10669
10670 Example :
10671 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10672 userlist stats-auth
10673 group admin users admin
10674 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10675 group readonly users haproxy
10676 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10677
10678 backend stats_auth
10679 stats enable
10680 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10681 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10682 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10683 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10684
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010685 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10686 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10687 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010688
10689
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010690stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10691 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010693 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010694 Arguments :
10695 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10696
10697 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10698
10699 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10700 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10701 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10702 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10703 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10704 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10705
10706 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10707 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10708 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010709 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010710
10711 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10712 report using "stats scope".
10713
10714 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10715 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10716 unobvious parameters.
10717
10718 Example :
10719 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10720 backend public_www
10721 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10722 stats enable
10723 stats hide-version
10724 stats scope .
10725 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010726 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010727 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10728 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10729
10730 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10731 backend private_monitoring
10732 stats enable
10733 stats uri /admin?stats
10734 stats refresh 5s
10735
10736 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10737
10738
10739stats enable
10740 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010742 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010743 Arguments : none
10744
10745 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10746 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10747 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10748 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10749 - stats auth : no authentication
10750 - stats scope : no restriction
10751
10752 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10753 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10754 unobvious parameters.
10755
10756 Example :
10757 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10758 backend public_www
10759 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10760 stats enable
10761 stats hide-version
10762 stats scope .
10763 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010764 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010765 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10766 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10767
10768 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10769 backend private_monitoring
10770 stats enable
10771 stats uri /admin?stats
10772 stats refresh 5s
10773
10774 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10775
10776
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010777stats hide-version
10778 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010780 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010781 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010782
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010783 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10784 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10785 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10786 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10787 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10788 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010790 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10791 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10792 unobvious parameters.
10793
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010794 Example :
10795 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10796 backend public_www
10797 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010798 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010799 stats hide-version
10800 stats scope .
10801 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010802 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010803 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10804 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010805
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010806 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10807 backend private_monitoring
10808 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010809 stats uri /admin?stats
10810 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010811
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010812 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010813
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010814
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010815stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10816 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10817 Access control for statistics
10818
10819 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10820 no | no | yes | yes
10821
10822 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10823 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10824 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10825 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10826 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10827 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10828
10829 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10830 instance.
10831
10832 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10833 about ACL usage.
10834
10835
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010836stats realm <realm>
10837 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010839 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010840 Arguments :
10841 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10842 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10843 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10844
10845 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10846 using a backslash ('\').
10847
10848 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10849 only related to authentication.
10850
10851 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10852 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10853 unobvious parameters.
10854
10855 Example :
10856 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10857 backend public_www
10858 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10859 stats enable
10860 stats hide-version
10861 stats scope .
10862 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010863 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010864 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10865 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10866
10867 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10868 backend private_monitoring
10869 stats enable
10870 stats uri /admin?stats
10871 stats refresh 5s
10872
10873 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10874
10875
10876stats refresh <delay>
10877 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010879 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010880 Arguments :
10881 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10882 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10883 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10884 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10885 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10886 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10887
10888 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10889 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10890 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010891 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010892
10893 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10894 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10895 unobvious parameters.
10896
10897 Example :
10898 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10899 backend public_www
10900 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10901 stats enable
10902 stats hide-version
10903 stats scope .
10904 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010905 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010906 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10907 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10908
10909 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10910 backend private_monitoring
10911 stats enable
10912 stats uri /admin?stats
10913 stats refresh 5s
10914
10915 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10916
10917
10918stats scope { <name> | "." }
10919 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010921 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010922 Arguments :
10923 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10924 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10925 section in which the statement appears.
10926
10927 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10928 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10929 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10930 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10931 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10932 exists.
10933
10934 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10935 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10936 unobvious parameters.
10937
10938 Example :
10939 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10940 backend public_www
10941 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10942 stats enable
10943 stats hide-version
10944 stats scope .
10945 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010946 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010947 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10948 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10949
10950 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10951 backend private_monitoring
10952 stats enable
10953 stats uri /admin?stats
10954 stats refresh 5s
10955
10956 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10957
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010958
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010959stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010960 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010962 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010963
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010964 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010965 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10966
10967 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10968 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10969
10970 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10971 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010972 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010973
10974 Example :
10975 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10976 backend private_monitoring
10977 stats enable
10978 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10979 stats uri /admin?stats
10980 stats refresh 5s
10981
10982 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10983 global section.
10984
10985
10986stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010987 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10989 yes | yes | yes | yes
10990 Arguments : none
10991
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010992 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010993 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10994 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10995 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10996 - IP (socket, server)
10997 - cookie (backend, server)
10998
10999 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11000 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011001 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011002
11003 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11004
11005
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011006stats show-modules
11007 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11009 yes | yes | yes | yes
11010 Arguments : none
11011
11012 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11013 values as a tooltip.
11014
11015 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11016 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11017 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11018
11019 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11020
11021
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011022stats show-node [ <name> ]
11023 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011025 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011026 Arguments:
11027 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11028 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11029
11030 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11031 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011032 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011033
11034 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11035 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11036 unobvious parameters.
11037
11038 Example:
11039 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11040 backend private_monitoring
11041 stats enable
11042 stats show-node Europe-1
11043 stats uri /admin?stats
11044 stats refresh 5s
11045
11046 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11047 section.
11048
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011049
11050stats uri <prefix>
11051 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011053 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011054 Arguments :
11055 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11056 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11057 query string.
11058
11059 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11060 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11061 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11062 possible to reach it in the application.
11063
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011064 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011065 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011066 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11067 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11068 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11069 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11070
11071 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11072 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11073 an address or a port to statistics only.
11074
11075 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11076 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11077 unobvious parameters.
11078
11079 Example :
11080 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11081 backend public_www
11082 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11083 stats enable
11084 stats hide-version
11085 stats scope .
11086 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011087 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011088 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11089 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11090
11091 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11092 backend private_monitoring
11093 stats enable
11094 stats uri /admin?stats
11095 stats refresh 5s
11096
11097 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11098
11099
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011100stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11101 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011103 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011104
11105 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011106 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011107 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011108 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011109 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11110
11111 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11112 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11113 the "stick-table" statement.
11114
11115 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11116 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11117 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11118 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11119 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11120
11121 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11122 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11123 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11124 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11125 transformation rules.
11126
11127 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11128 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11129 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11130 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11131 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11132 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11133 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11134
11135 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11136 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11137 ACL based conditions.
11138
11139 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11140 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11141 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11142 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11143
11144 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11145 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11146 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11147 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11148
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011149 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11150 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011151 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011152
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011153 Example :
11154 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11155 # last 30 minutes
11156 backend pop
11157 mode tcp
11158 balance roundrobin
11159 stick store-request src
11160 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11161 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11162 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11163
11164 backend smtp
11165 mode tcp
11166 balance roundrobin
11167 stick match src table pop
11168 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11169 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11170
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011171 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011172 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011173
11174
11175stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11176 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11178 no | no | yes | yes
11179
11180 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11181 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11182 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11183 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11184
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011185 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11186 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011187 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011188
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011189 Examples :
11190 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011191 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011192
11193 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11194 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11195 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11196
11197
11198 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11199 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11200 backend http
11201 mode http
11202 balance roundrobin
11203 stick on src table https
11204 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11205 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11206 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11207
11208 backend https
11209 mode tcp
11210 balance roundrobin
11211 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11212 stick on src
11213 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11214 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11215
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011216 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011217
11218
11219stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11220 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11222 no | no | yes | yes
11223
11224 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011225 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011226 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011227 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011228 server is selected.
11229
11230 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11231 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11232 the "stick-table" statement.
11233
11234 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11235 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11236 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11237 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11238 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11239 address.
11240
11241 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11242 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11243 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11244 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11245 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11246 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11247 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11248 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11249 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11250 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11251
11252 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11253 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11254 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11255 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11256 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11257 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11258 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11259
11260 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11261 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11262 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11263 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11264
11265 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11266 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11267 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11268 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11269 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11270 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011271 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11272 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11273 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11274 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11275 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11276 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011277
11278 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11279 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11280 the request.
11281
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011282 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11283 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011284 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011285
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011286 Example :
11287 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11288 # last 30 minutes
11289 backend pop
11290 mode tcp
11291 balance roundrobin
11292 stick store-request src
11293 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11294 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11295 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11296
11297 backend smtp
11298 mode tcp
11299 balance roundrobin
11300 stick match src table pop
11301 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11302 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11303
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011304 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011305 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011306
11307
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011308stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011309 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011310 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011311 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011313 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011314
11315 Arguments :
11316 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11317 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11318 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11319 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11320
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011321 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11322 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11323 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11324 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11325
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011326 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11327 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11328 instance.
11329
11330 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11331 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11332 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11333 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11334 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11335 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011336 to 32 characters.
11337
11338 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11339 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11340 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011341 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011342 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11343 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011344
11345 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011346 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11347 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011348 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11349 increase.
11350
11351 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011352 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11353 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11354 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011355
11356 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011357 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011358 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11359 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011360 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011361 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11362 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11363 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11364 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11365 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11366 parameter (see below).
11367
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011368 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11369 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11370 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11371 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11372 soft restart.
11373
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011374 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11375 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011376
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011377 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011378 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11379 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011380 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11381 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011382 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011383 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011384 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11385 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011386 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11387 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011388
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011389 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11390 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11391 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11392 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11393 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11394 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11395 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11396 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11397 token.
11398
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011399 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11400 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11401 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11402 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011403 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11404 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11405 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11406 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11407 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11408 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11409 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11410 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11411 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11412 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11413 types and their arguments.
11414
11415 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11416 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11417 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11418 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11419
11420 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11421 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11422 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011423 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011424
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011425 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11426 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11427 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011428 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011429 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011430 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011431
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011432 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11433 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11434 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11435 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11436
11437 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11438 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11439 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11440 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11441 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11442 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11443
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011444 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11445 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11446 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11447 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11448
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011449 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11450 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11451 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11452 they were received.
11453
11454 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11455 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11456 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11457 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11458 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11459
11460 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11461 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11462 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11463 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11464 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11465
11466 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11467 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11468 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11469
11470 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11471 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11472 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11473 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11474 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11475
11476 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11477 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11478 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11479 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11480 the client side.
11481
11482 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11483 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11484 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11485 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11486 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11487 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11488 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11489
11490 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11491 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11492 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11493 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11494 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11495 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011496 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011497
11498 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11499 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11500 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11501 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11502 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11503 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11504
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011505 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11506 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11507 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11508 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11509 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11510
11511 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11512 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11513 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11514 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11515 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11516 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11517
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011518 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011519 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011520 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11521 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11522
11523 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11524 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11525 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11526 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11527 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11528 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11529 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11530 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11531 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11532 recommended for better fairness.
11533
11534 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011535 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011536 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11537 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11538
11539 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11540 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11541 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11542 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11543 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11544 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11545 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11546 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11547 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11548 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011549
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011550 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11551 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011552 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11553 reference it.
11554
11555 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11556 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011557 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11558 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11559 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011560
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011561 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11562 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11563 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11564 something that can be ignored.
11565
11566 Example:
11567 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11568 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11569 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11570 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11571
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011572 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011573 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011574
11575
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011576stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011577 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11579 no | no | yes | yes
11580
11581 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011582 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011583 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011584 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011585 server is selected.
11586
11587 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11588 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11589 the "stick-table" statement.
11590
11591 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11592 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11593 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11594 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11595
11596 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11597 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11598 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11599 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11600 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11601 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011602 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011603 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11604 rules.
11605
11606 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11607 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11608 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11609 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11610 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11611 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11612 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11613
11614 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11615 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11616 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11617 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11618
11619 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11620 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11621 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11622 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11623 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11624 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011625 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11626 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11627 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11628 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11629 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11630 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11631 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11632 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11633 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011634
11635 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11636
11637 Example :
11638 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11639 backend https
11640 mode tcp
11641 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011642 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011643 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011644
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011645 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11646 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011647
11648 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11649 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11650 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11651
11652 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11653 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011654
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011655 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11656 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11657 # at offset 44.
11658
11659 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011660 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011661
11662 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011663 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011664
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011665 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11666 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11667
11668 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11669 extraction.
11670
11671
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011672tcp-check comment <string>
11673 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11674 it fails.
11675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11676 yes | no | yes | yes
11677
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011678 Arguments :
11679 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11680 rule fails.
11681
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011682 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11683 user-friendly error reporting.
11684
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011685 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11686 "tcp-check expect".
11687
11688
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011689tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11690 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011691 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011692 Opens a new connection
11693 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011694 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011695
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011696 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011697 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11698
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011699 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011700 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011701
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011702 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011703 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11704 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011705 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011706
11707 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011708
11709 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11710
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011711 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11712
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011713 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11714
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011715 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11716
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011717 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11718 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11719 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11720 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11721
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011722 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11723 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11724 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11725 haproxy -vv.
11726
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011727 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011728
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011729 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11730 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11731 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11732
11733 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11734 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11735 of the sequence.
11736
11737 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11738 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11739 do.
11740
11741 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11742 unset-var or comment rules.
11743
11744 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011745 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11746 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11747 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11748 option tcp-check
11749 tcp-check connect
11750 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11751 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11752 tcp-check send \r\n
11753 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11754 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11755 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11756 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11757 tcp-check send \r\n
11758 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11759 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11760
11761 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11762 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011763 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011764 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11765 tcp-check connect port 143
11766 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11767 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11768
11769 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11770
11771
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011772tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011773 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011774 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011775 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011776 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011778 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011779
11780 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011781 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11782
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011783 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11784 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11785 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11786 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11787 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11788 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11789 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11790 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11791 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11792 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11793
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011794 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011795 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11796 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011797 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11798 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11799 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11800
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011801 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11802 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11803 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011804 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11805 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011806 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11807 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011808 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11809 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011810 By default "L7OK" is used.
11811
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011812 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11813 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011814 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11815 supported :
11816 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11817 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011818 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11819 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11820 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11821 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11822 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011823
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011824 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011825 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011826 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11827 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11828 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11829 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011830 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11831
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011832 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11833 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11834 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11835 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11836
11837 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11838 informational message reported in logs if an error
11839 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11840 log-format string.
11841
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011842 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11843 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11844 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11845 followed by some converters.
11846
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011847 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11848 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11849 with the usual backslash ('\').
11850 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011851 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011852 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11853 used upper or lower case.
11854
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011855 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11856
11857 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11858 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11859 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11860 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11861 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11862 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11863 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11864 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11865
11866 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11867 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11868 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11869 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11870 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11871 expression.
11872
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011873 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11874 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11875 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11876 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11877 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11878 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11879
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011880 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11881 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11882 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11883 this exact hexadecimal string.
11884 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11885
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011886 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11887 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11888 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11889 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11890 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11891 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11892 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11893 size.
11894
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011895 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11896 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11897 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11898 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11899 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11900 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11901 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11902 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11903 in a binary string before matching the response's
11904 buffer.
11905
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011906 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011907 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011908 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11909 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11910 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11911 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11912 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11913 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11914 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11915 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11916 the null character.
11917
11918 Examples :
11919 # perform a POP check
11920 option tcp-check
11921 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11922
11923 # perform an IMAP check
11924 option tcp-check
11925 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11926
11927 # look for the redis master server
11928 option tcp-check
11929 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011930 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011931 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11932 tcp-check expect string role:master
11933 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11934 tcp-check expect string +OK
11935
11936
11937 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011938 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011939
11940
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011941tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11942tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11943 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11944 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011945 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011946 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011947
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011948 Arguments :
11949 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11950
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011951 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11952 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011953
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011954 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11955 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011956
11957 Examples :
11958 # look for the redis master server
11959 option tcp-check
11960 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11961 tcp-check expect string role:master
11962
11963 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011964 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011965
11966
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011967tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11968tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11969 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11970 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011971 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011972 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011973
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011974 Arguments :
11975 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011976
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011977 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11978 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011979
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011980 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11981 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11982 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011983
11984 Examples :
11985 # redis check in binary
11986 option tcp-check
11987 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11988 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11989
11990
11991 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011992 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011993
11994
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011995tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011996 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011997 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011998 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011999
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012000 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012001 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12002 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12003 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12004 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12005 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12006 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12007 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12008 and '-'.
12009
12010 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12011
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012012 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012013 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
12014
12015
12016tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012017 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012018 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012019 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012020
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012021 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012022 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12023 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12024 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12025 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12026 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12027 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12028 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12029 and '-'.
12030
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012031 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012032 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12033
12034
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012035tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12036 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12038 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012039 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012040 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12041 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012042
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012043 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012044
12045 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12046 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012047 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12048 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12049 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12050 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12051 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12052 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012054 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12055 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12056 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12057 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012058
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012059 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012060 - accept :
12061 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12062 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12063 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012064
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012065 - reject :
12066 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12067 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12068 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12069 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12070 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12071 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12072 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12073 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12074 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12075 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12076 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012077 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012078
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012079 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12080 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12081 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12082 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12083 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12084 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12085 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12086 hosts.
12087
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012088 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12089 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12090 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12091 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12092 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12093 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12094 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12095 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12096
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012097 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12098 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12099 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12100 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12101 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12102 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12103 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12104 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12105 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012106 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12107 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012108
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012109 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012110 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012111 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12112 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12113 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012114 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012115 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012116 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12117 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12118 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12119 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12120 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12121 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12122 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012123
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012124 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012125 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012126 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012127 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012128 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12129 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12130 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012131
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012132 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12133 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12134 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12135 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012136
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012137 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12138 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12139 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12140 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12141 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012142 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12143 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12144 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12145 layer7 information is extracted.
12146
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012147 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12148 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12149 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12150 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12151 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012152
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012153 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12154 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12155 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12156 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12157
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012158 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12159 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12160 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12161 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12162
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012163 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12164 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12165 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12166 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12167 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012168
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012169 - set-src <expr> :
12170 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12171 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12172 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012173 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012175 Arguments:
12176 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12177 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012178
12179 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012180 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12181
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012182 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12183 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012184
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012185 - set-src-port <expr> :
12186 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12187 expression.
12188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012189 Arguments:
12190 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12191 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012192
12193 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012194 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12195
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012196 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12197 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12198 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012199
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012200 - set-dst <expr> :
12201 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12202 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12203 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12204 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12205 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12206
12207 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12208 followed by some converters.
12209
12210 Example:
12211
12212 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12213 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12214
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012215 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12216 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12217
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012218 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12219 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12220 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12221 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12222
12223
12224 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12225 followed by some converters.
12226
12227 Example:
12228
12229 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12230
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012231 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12232 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12233 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12234
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012235 - "silent-drop" :
12236 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012237 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012238 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12239 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12240 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12241 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12242 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012243 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12244 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012245 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12246 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012247 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012248 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12249 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12250 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12251 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12252
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012253 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12254 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12255 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012256
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012257 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12258 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12259 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012260
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012261 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012262 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012263 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012264
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012265 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12266 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12267 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012268
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012269 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012270 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12271 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012272
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012273 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12274
12275 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12276
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012277 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12278
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012279 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012280
12281
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012282tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12283 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012285 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012286 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012287 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12288 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012289
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012290 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012292 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012293 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12294 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012295 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12296 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012297
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012298 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12299 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12300 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12301 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012302 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012303 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012304 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12305 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12306 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12307 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012308 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012309 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012310
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012311 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12312 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12313 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12314 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012315
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012316 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012317 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012318 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012319 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12320 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012321 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012322 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012323 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012324 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012325 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012326 - set-dst <expr>
12327 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012328 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012329 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012330 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012331 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012332 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012333 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012334
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012335 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12336 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012337 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12338 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012339
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012340 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12341 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12342 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12343 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12344 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12345 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012347 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012348 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12349 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012350
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012351 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12352 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12353 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12354 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12355 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12356 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12357
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012358 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012359 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12360 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12361 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12362 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12363 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12364 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12365 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12366 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12367 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12368 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012369
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012370 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012371 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12372 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12373 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012374
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012375 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12376 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12377
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012378 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012379 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12380 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012381
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012382 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12383 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012384 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012385 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12386 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012387 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012388 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012389 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012390 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12391 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012392 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012393 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12394 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012395
12396 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12397 followed by some converters.
12398
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012399 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012400 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12401 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12402 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12403 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12404 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12405 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012406 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012407 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12408 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12409
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012410 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12411
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012412 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12413 <var-name>.
12414
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012415 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12416 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12417 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12418 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12419 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12420
12421 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12422 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12423 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12424 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12425 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12426 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12427 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12428 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12429 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12430 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12431 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12432
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012433 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12434 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12435 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12436 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12437 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12438
12439 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12440
12441 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12442
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012443 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12444 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12445 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12446 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12447 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12448 evaluated.
12449
12450 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONdf332122022-10-05 18:09:33 +020012451 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012452
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012453 Example:
12454
12455 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012456 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012457
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012458 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012459 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012460 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012461 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12462 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012463 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012464 tcp-request content reject
12465
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012466 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12467 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12468 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12469 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12470 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12471 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12472 ...
12473 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12474
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012475 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012476 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12477 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012478 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012479 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012480
12481 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12482 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012483 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012484 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012485 tcp-request content reject
12486
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012487 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012488 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012489 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012490 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012491 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12492 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012493
12494 Example:
12495 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12496 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012497 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012498
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012499 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012500 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012501
12502 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012503 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012504 # protecting all our sites
12505 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012506 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12507 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012508 ...
12509 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12510
12511 backend http_dynamic
12512 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012513 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012514 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012515 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012516 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012517 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012518 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012520 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012521
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012522 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12523 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012524
12525
12526tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12527 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012529 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012530 Arguments :
12531 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12532 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12533 as explained at the top of this document.
12534
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012535 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012536 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12537 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12538 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12539 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12540
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012541 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12542 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12543 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12544 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12545
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012546 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012547 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012548 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012549 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012550 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012551 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12552 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12553 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012554
12555 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12556 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12557 it pass through unaffected.
12558
12559 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12560 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12561 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012562 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012563 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12564 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012565 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12566 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12567 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012568
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012569 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012570 "timeout client".
12571
12572
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012573tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12574 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12576 no | no | yes | yes
12577 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012578 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12579 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012580
12581 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12582
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012583 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012584 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12585 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012586 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12587 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012588
12589 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12590
12591 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12592 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12593 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12594 inserted.
12595
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012596 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012597 - accept :
12598 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12599 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12600 the rules evaluation.
12601
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012602 - close :
12603 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12604 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12605 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12606 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12607 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12608 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012609 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012610 protocols.
12611
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012612 - reject :
12613 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12614 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012615 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012616
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012617 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012618 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012619
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012620 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12621 Unsets a variable.
12622
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012623 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12624 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12625 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12626 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12627
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012628 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12629 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12630 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12631 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12632
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012633 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12634 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12635 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12636 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12637 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012638
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012639 - "silent-drop" :
12640 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012641 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012642 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12643 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12644 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12645 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12646 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012647 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12648 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012649 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12650 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012651 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012652 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12653 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12654 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12655 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12656
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012657 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12658 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12659
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012660 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12661 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12662 for changing the default action to a reject.
12663
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012664 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12665 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12666 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12667 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012668 period.
12669
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012670 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12671 declared inline.
12672
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012673 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12674 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012675 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012676 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12677 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012678 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012679 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012680 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012681 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12682 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012683 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012684 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12685 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012686
12687 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12688 followed by some converters.
12689
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012690 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12691 <var-name>.
12692
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012693 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12694 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12695 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12696 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12697 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12698
12699 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12700
12701 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12702
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012703 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12704
12705 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12706
12707
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012708tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12709 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12711 no | yes | yes | no
12712 Arguments :
12713 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12714 below.
12715
12716 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12717
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012718 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012719 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12720 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12721 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12722 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12723 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12724 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12725 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012726 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012727 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12728 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12729 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12730 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12731 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12732 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12733 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12734 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12735 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12736 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12737 instead.
12738
12739 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12740 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12741 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12742 rules which may be inserted.
12743
12744 Several types of actions are supported :
12745 - accept : the request is accepted
12746 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12747 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12748 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012749 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012750 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012751 - set-dst <expr>
12752 - set-dst-port <expr>
12753 - set-src <expr>
12754 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012755 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012756 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012757 - silent-drop
12758
12759 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12760 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12761 sections for a complete description.
12762
12763 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12764 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12765 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12766
12767 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12768 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12769 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12770 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12771 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12772
12773 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12774 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12775
12776 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12777 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12778 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12779
12780 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12781 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12782 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12783
12784 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12785 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12786 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12787
12788 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12789 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12790 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12791
12792 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12793
12794 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12795
12796
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012797tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12798 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12800 no | no | yes | yes
12801 Arguments :
12802 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12803 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12804 as explained at the top of this document.
12805
12806 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12807
12808
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012809timeout check <timeout>
12810 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12811 established.
12812
12813 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12814 yes | no | yes | yes
12815 Arguments:
12816 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12817 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12818 as explained at the top of this document.
12819
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012820 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012821 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012822 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012823 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012824 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12825 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12826 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012827
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012828 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012829 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12830
12831 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12832 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012833 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012834
12835 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12836 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12837 forget about it.
12838
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012839 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12840 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012841
12842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012843timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012844 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12846 yes | yes | yes | no
12847 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012848 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012849 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12850 as explained at the top of this document.
12851
12852 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12853 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12854 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012855 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12856 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12857 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12858 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012859 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12860 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12861 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012862 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012863 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012864 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12865 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012866 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12867 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012868
12869 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12870 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12871 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12872 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012873 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012874 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12875
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012876 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012878
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012879timeout client-fin <timeout>
12880 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12882 yes | yes | yes | no
12883 Arguments :
12884 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12885 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12886 as explained at the top of this document.
12887
12888 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12889 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12890 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12891 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12892 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12893 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12894 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012895 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12896 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12897 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012898
12899 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12900 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12901 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12902
12903 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12904
12905
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012906timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012907 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12909 yes | no | yes | yes
12910 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012911 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012912 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12913 as explained at the top of this document.
12914
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012915 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012916 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012917 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012918 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012919 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12920 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012921
12922 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12923 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12924 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12925 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012926 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012927 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12928
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012929 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012931
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012932timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12933 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12935 yes | yes | yes | yes
12936 Arguments :
12937 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12938 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12939 as explained at the top of this document.
12940
12941 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12942 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12943 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12944 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12945 once the request has started to present itself.
12946
12947 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12948 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12949 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12950 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12951 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12952
12953 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12954 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12955 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12956 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12957
12958 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12959 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012960 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012961 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12962 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012963 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012964
12965 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12966 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12967 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12968 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12969
12970 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12971
12972
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012973timeout http-request <timeout>
12974 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012976 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012977 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012978 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012979 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12980 as explained at the top of this document.
12981
12982 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12983 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12984 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12985 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12986 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12987 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12988 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012989 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12990 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12991 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12992 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012993 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012994 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12995 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012996
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012997 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12998 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12999 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13000 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13001 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013002 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013003
13004 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13005 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013006 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013007 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13008 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13009
13010 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013011 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13012 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13013 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013014
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013015 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013016 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013017
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013018
13019timeout queue <timeout>
13020 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13022 yes | no | yes | yes
13023 Arguments :
13024 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13025 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13026 as explained at the top of this document.
13027
13028 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13029 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13030 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13031 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13032 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13033
13034 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13035 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13036 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13037 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13038
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013039 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013040
13041
13042timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013043 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13045 yes | no | yes | yes
13046 Arguments :
13047 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13048 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13049 as explained at the top of this document.
13050
13051 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13052 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13053 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13054 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13055 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13056 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13057 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13058
13059 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13060 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13061 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13062 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13063 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013064 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013065 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013066 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13067 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013068 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13069 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013070
13071 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13072 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13073 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13074 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013075 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013076 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13077
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013078 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013079
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013080
13081timeout server-fin <timeout>
13082 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13084 yes | no | yes | yes
13085 Arguments :
13086 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13087 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13088 as explained at the top of this document.
13089
13090 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13091 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13092 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13093 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13094 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13095 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13096 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13097 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13098 situations, it should not be needed.
13099
13100 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13101 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13102 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13103
13104 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13105
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013106
13107timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013108 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13110 yes | yes | yes | yes
13111 Arguments :
13112 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13113 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13114 as explained at the top of this document.
13115
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013116 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13117 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13118 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013119
13120 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13121 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13122 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13123 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013124 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013125
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013126 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013127
13128
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013129timeout tunnel <timeout>
13130 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13132 yes | no | yes | yes
13133 Arguments :
13134 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13135 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13136 as explained at the top of this document.
13137
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013138 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013139 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13140 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13141 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013142 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13143 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013144 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13145 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13146 specified.
13147
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013148 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13149 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13150 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13151 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13152 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13153 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13154 state.
13155
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013156 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13157 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13158 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13159 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013160 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013161
13162 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13163 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13164 forget about it.
13165
13166 Example :
13167 defaults http
13168 option http-server-close
13169 timeout connect 5s
13170 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013171 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013172 timeout server 30s
13173 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13174
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013175 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013176
13177
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013178transparent (deprecated)
13179 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013181 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013182 Arguments : none
13183
13184 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13185 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13186 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13187 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13188 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13189 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13190 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13191 appropriate server.
13192
13193 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13194
13195 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13196 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13197
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013198 See also: "option transparent"
13199
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013200unique-id-format <string>
13201 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13203 yes | yes | yes | no
13204 Arguments :
13205 <string> is a log-format string.
13206
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013207 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13208 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13209 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13210 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013211
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013212 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013213 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013214 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13215 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13216 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13217 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13218 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13219 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013220
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013221 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13222 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013223
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013224 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013225
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013226 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013227
13228 will generate:
13229
13230 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13231
13232 See also: "unique-id-header"
13233
13234unique-id-header <name>
13235 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13237 yes | yes | yes | no
13238 Arguments :
13239 <name> is the name of the header.
13240
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013241 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13242 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013243
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013244 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013245
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013246 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013247 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13248
13249 will generate:
13250
13251 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13252
13253 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013254
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013255use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013256 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13258 no | yes | yes | no
13259 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013260 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13261 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013262
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013263 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13264 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013265
13266 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13267 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13268 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013269 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013270 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013271 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13272 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013273
13274 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13275 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13276 assign the backend.
13277
13278 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13279 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13280 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13281 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13282 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13283 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13284
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013285 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013286 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013287 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13288 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13289 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13290
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013291 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13292 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13293 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13294 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13295 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13296 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13297 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13298 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13299 cannot be forced from the request.
13300
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013301 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013302 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13303 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13304
13305 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13306 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013307
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013308use-fcgi-app <name>
13309 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13311 no | no | yes | yes
13312 Arguments :
13313 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13314
13315 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013316
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013317use-server <server> if <condition>
13318use-server <server> unless <condition>
13319 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13321 no | no | yes | yes
13322 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013323 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13324 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013325
13326 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13327
13328 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13329 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13330 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13331
13332 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13333 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13334 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13335 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13336 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13337 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13338 matches will assign the server.
13339
13340 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13341 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13342 with the next rules until one matches.
13343
13344 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13345 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13346 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13347 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13348
13349 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13350 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13351 stripped.
13352
13353 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13354 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013355 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013356 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013357 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013358
13359 Example :
13360 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013361 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013362 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013363 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013364 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013365 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013366 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013367 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13368 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13369
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013370 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13371 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13372 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13373 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013374 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013375 and we fall back to load balancing.
13376
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013377 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013378
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013379
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133805. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013381--------------------------
13382
13383The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13384depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13385settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13386written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13387described in this section.
13388
13389
133905.1. Bind options
13391-----------------
13392
13393The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13394as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13395no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13396parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13397while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13398provided immediately after the setting name.
13399
13400The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13401
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013402accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13403 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13404 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13405 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13406 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13407 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13408 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13409 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13410 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13411 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013412 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13413 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13414 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013415
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013416accept-proxy
13417 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013418 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13419 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013420 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13421 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13422 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13423 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013424 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013425 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13426 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013427 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13428 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013429
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013430allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013431 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013432 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013433 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013434 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13435 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013436
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013437alpn <protocols>
13438 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13439 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13440 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013441 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013442 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013443 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13444 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13445 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13446 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13447 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13448 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13449 preference, like below :
13450
13451 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013452
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013453backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013454 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013455 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13456
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013457curves <curves>
13458 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13459 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13460 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13461 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13462 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13463 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13464
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013465ecdhe <named curve>
13466 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013467 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13468 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013469
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013470ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013471 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13472 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13473 client's certificate.
13474
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013475ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13476 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13477 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13478 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13479 error is ignored.
13480
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013481ca-sign-file <cafile>
13482 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13483 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13484 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13485 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13486 'generate-certificates' for details.
13487
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013488ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013489 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13490 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13491 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13492 'generate-certificates' for details.
13493
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013494ca-verify-file <cafile>
13495 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13496 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13497 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13498 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13499 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13500
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013501ciphers <ciphers>
13502 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13503 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013504 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013505 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013506 information and recommendations see e.g.
13507 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13508 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13509 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13510
13511ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13512 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13513 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13514 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13515 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013516 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13517 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013518
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013519crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013520 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13521 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013522 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13523 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013524
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013525crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013526 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13527 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13528 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13529 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13530 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013531 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13532 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013533
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013534 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13535 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13536
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013537 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13538 are loaded.
13539
13540 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013541 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13542 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13543 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13544 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13545 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13546 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13547 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013548 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013549
13550 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13551 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13552 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13553 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013554 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13555 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013556
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013557 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013558
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013559 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013560 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013561 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13562 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013563 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13564 clients).
13565
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013566 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013567 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13568 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13569 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13570 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13571 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13572 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13573 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13574 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13575 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13576 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13577 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13578 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13579
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013580 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013581 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13582 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13583 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13584 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13585
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013586 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13587 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13588 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13589 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013590
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013591 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13592 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13593 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013594
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013595crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013597 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013598 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013599 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013600
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013601crt-list <file>
13602 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013603 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13604 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013605
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013606 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13607
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013608 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13609 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13610 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13611 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13612 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013613
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013614 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013615 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13616 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13617 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13618 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13619 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013620 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13621 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13622 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013623
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013624 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13625 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13626 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013627
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013628 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13629
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013630 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013631 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013632 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13633 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13634 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13635 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13636 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13637 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013638
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013639 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013640 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013641 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013642 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013643 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013644 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013645
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013646defer-accept
13647 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13648 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13649 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013650 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013651 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13652 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13653 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13654 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13655 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13656 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13657 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13658
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013659expose-fd listeners
13660 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13661 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013662 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13663 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013664 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013665
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013666force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013667 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013668 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013669 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013670 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013671
13672force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013673 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013674 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013675 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013676
13677force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013678 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013679 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013680 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013681
13682force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013683 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013684 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013685 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013686
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013687force-tlsv13
13688 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13689 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013690 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013691
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013692generate-certificates
13693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13694 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13695 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13696 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13697 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13698 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13699 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13700 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13701 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13702 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13703 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13704
13705 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13706 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013707 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013708 certificate is used many times.
13709
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013710gid <gid>
13711 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13712 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13713 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13714 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13715 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13716
13717group <group>
13718 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13719 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13720 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13721 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13722 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13723
13724id <id>
13725 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13726 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13727 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13728 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13729
13730interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013731 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13732 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13733 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13734 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13735 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13736 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013737 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13738 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13739 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13740 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13741 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13742 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013743
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013744level <level>
13745 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13746 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13747 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013748 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013749 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13750 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13751 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013752 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013753 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013754 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013755 all counters).
13756
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013757severity-output <format>
13758 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13759 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13760 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13761 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13762 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13763 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13764 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13765 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13766 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13767 rfc5424 convention.
13768
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013769maxconn <maxconn>
13770 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13771 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13772 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13773 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13774 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13775 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13776 eat all memory.
13777
13778mode <mode>
13779 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13780 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13781 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13782 UNIX sockets.
13783
13784mss <maxseg>
13785 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13786 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13787 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13788 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13789 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13790 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13791 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13792 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13793 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13794 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13795 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13796
13797name <name>
13798 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13799 page.
13800
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013801namespace <name>
13802 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13803 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13804 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13805 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13806
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013807nice <nice>
13808 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13809 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13810 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13811 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13812 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13813 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13814 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13815 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13816 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13817 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13818 one for an RDP socket.
13819
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013820no-ca-names
13821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13822 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013823 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013824
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013825no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013826 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013827 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013828 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013829 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013830 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13831 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013832
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013833no-tls-tickets
13834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13835 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13836 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013837 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13838 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013839 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13840 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13841 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013842
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013843no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013844 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013845 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013846 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013847 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013848 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13849 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013850
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013851no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013852 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013853 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013854 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013855 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013856 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13857 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013858
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013859no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013860 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013861 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013862 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013863 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013864 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13865 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013866
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013867no-tlsv13
13868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13869 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13870 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13871 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013872 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13873 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013874
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013875npn <protocols>
13876 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13877 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13878 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013879 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013880 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013881 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13882 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13883 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13884 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13885 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013886
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013887prefer-client-ciphers
13888 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13889 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13890 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013891 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13892 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13893 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013894
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013895process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013896 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013897 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013898 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013899 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13900 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13901 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13902 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013903 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013904 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13905 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13906 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13907 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13908 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013909
13910 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13911
13912 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13913 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13914 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13915 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13916 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13917 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13918 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13919 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013920
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013921proto <name>
13922 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13923 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13924 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013925 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13926 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13927
13928 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13929 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13930 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13931 also reported (flag=HTX).
13932
13933 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13934 a bind line :
13935
13936 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13937 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13938 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13939
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013940 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013941 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013942 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013943 h2" on the bind line.
13944
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013945ssl
13946 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013947 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013948 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13949 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013950 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13951 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013952
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013953ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13954 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013955 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13956 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13957 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013958 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13959
13960ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013961 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13962 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13963 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13964 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013965
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013966strict-sni
13967 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13968 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13969 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13970 See the "crt" option for more information.
13971
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013972tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013973 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013974 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013975 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013976 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013977 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13978 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13979 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13980 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13981 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13982 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13983 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13984
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013985tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013986 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013987 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13988 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13989 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13990 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13991 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13992 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13993 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013994 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13995 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13996 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013997
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013998tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13999 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014000 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14001 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14002 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14003 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14004 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14005 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14006 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14007 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14008 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14009 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014010 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14011 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14012
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014013transparent
14014 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14015 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14016 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14017 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14018 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14019 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14020 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14021 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14022 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14023 so check for support with your vendor.
14024
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014025v4v6
14026 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14027 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14028 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14029 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014030 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014031
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014032v6only
14033 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14034 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14035 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014036 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14037 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014038
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014039uid <uid>
14040 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14041 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14042 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14043 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14044 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14045
14046user <user>
14047 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14048 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14049 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14050 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14051 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14052
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014053verify [none|optional|required]
14054 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14055 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14056 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14057 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14058 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014059 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14060 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14061 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14062 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014063
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140645.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014065------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014067The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14068which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14069arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14070settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14071after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14072Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14073address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014075 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014076 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014077
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014078Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14079keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14080
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014081The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014082
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014083addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014084 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014085 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14086 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14087 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14088 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14089 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014090
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014091agent-check
14092 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014093 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014094 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14095 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14096 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014097
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014098 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014099 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014100 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014101 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14102 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014103
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014104 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14105 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14106 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14107 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14108 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014109
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014110 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014111 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014112
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014113 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14114 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14115 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014116
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014117 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14118 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14119 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014120
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014121 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014122 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14123 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14124 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14125 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014126 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014127 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014128
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014129 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14130 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014131
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014132 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14133 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14134 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14135 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14136 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14137 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14138 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14139 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14140 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014141
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014142 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14143 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014144 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14145 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14146 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014147 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014148
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014149 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014150 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014151
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014152agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014153 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014154 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14155 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14156 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14157 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14158
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014159agent-inter <delay>
14160 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14161 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14162
14163 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14164 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14165 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14166 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14167 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14168 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14169 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14170 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14171 of backends use the same servers.
14172
14173 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14174
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014175agent-addr <addr>
14176 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14177
14178 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014179 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014180 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14181 hostname, it will be resolved.
14182
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014183agent-port <port>
14184 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14185
14186 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14187
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014188allow-0rtt
14189 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014190 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14191 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014192
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014193alpn <protocols>
14194 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14195 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14196 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014197 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014198 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14199 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14200 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14201 now obsolete NPN extension.
14202 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14203 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14204
14205 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14206
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014207 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014209backup
14210 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14211 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14212 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14213 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014214 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14215 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014216
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014217ca-file <cafile>
14218 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14219 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14220 server's certificate.
14221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014222check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014223 This option enables health checks on a server:
14224 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14225 considered available.
14226 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14227 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14228 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14229 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14230 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14231 set.
14232 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14233 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14234 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14235 exchanges succeed.
14236
14237 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14238 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14239 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14240 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14241 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014242 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014243 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14244
14245 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14246 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14247
14248 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14249 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14250
14251 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14252 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14253 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14254 available.
14255
14256 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14257 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14258 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14259
14260 Example:
14261 # simple tcp check
14262 backend foo
14263 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14264 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14265 backend foo
14266 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14267 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14268 backend foo
14269 option tcp-check
14270 tcp-check connect
14271 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014272
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014273check-send-proxy
14274 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14275 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14276 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14277 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14278 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14279 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14280 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14281
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014282check-alpn <protocols>
14283 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14284 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14285 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14286
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014287check-proto <name>
14288 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14289 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14290 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014291 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14292 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14293
14294 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14295 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14296 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14297 also reported (flag=HTX).
14298
14299 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14300 directive on a server line:
14301
14302 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14303 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14304 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14305 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14306
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014307 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014308 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14309 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14310
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014311check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014312 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014313 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14314 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014315
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014316check-ssl
14317 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14318 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14319 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14320 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014321 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014322 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14323 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014324 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014325 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14326 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014327
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014328check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014329 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014330 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14331 for normal traffic.
14332
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014333ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014334 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14335 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14336 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014337 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14338 information and recommendations see e.g.
14339 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14340 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14341 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014342
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014343ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14344 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14345 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14346 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14347 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014348 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14349 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14350 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014352cookie <value>
14353 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14354 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14355 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14356 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14357 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14358 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14359 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14360
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014361crl-file <crlfile>
14362 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14363 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14364 to verify server's certificate.
14365
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014366crt <cert>
14367 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14368 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14369 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14370 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14371 certificate request.
14372
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014373 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14374 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14375 option is set accordingly).
14376
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014377disabled
14378 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14379 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14380 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14381 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14382 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014383 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014384
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014385enabled
14386 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14387 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14388 default value.
14389 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14390 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014391
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014392error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014393 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14394 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14395 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014397 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014398
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014399fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014400 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14401 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14402 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14403
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014404force-sslv3
14405 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14406 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014407 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014408 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014409
14410force-tlsv10
14411 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014412 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014413 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014414
14415force-tlsv11
14416 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014417 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014418 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014419
14420force-tlsv12
14421 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014422 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014423 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014424
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014425force-tlsv13
14426 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14427 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014428 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014430id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014431 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14432 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14433 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014434
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014435init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14436 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14437 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014438 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014439 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14440 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14441 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14442 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14443 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14444 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14445 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14446 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14447 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014448 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014449 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14450 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14451 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14452 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14453 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14454 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014455 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014456
14457 Example:
14458 defaults
14459 # never fail on address resolution
14460 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14461
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014462inter <delay>
14463fastinter <delay>
14464downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014465 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14466 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14467 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14468 between checks depending on the server state :
14469
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014470 Server state | Interval used
14471 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14472 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14473 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14474 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14475 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14476 or yet unchecked. |
14477 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14478 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14479 | "inter" otherwise.
14480 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014482 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14483 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14484 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14485 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014486 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14487 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14488 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14489 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14490 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014491
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014492log-proto <logproto>
14493 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14494 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14495 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14496 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14497
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014498maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014499 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14500 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014501 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14502 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014503 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14504 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14505 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14506 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14507
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014508 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14509 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14510 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14511 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14512 than 50 concurrent requests.
14513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014514maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014515 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14516 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14517 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14518 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014519 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14520 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14521 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14522 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14523 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14524 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14525 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014526
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014527max-reuse <count>
14528 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14529 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14530 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14531 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14532 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14533 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14534 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14535 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014537minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014538 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14539 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14540 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14541 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14542 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14543 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014544 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014545 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014546
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014547namespace <name>
14548 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14549 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14550 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14551 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14552
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014553no-agent-check
14554 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14555 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14556 default value.
14557 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14558 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14559
14560no-backup
14561 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14562 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14563 default value.
14564 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14565 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14566
14567no-check
14568 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14569 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14570 default value.
14571 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14572 "default-server" "check" setting.
14573
14574no-check-ssl
14575 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14576 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14577 default value.
14578 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14579 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14580
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014581no-send-proxy
14582 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14583 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14584 default value.
14585 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14586 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14587
14588no-send-proxy-v2
14589 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14590 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14591 default value.
14592 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14593 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14594
14595no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14596 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14597 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14598 default value.
14599 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14600 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14601
14602no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14603 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14604 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14605 default value.
14606 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14607 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14608
14609no-ssl
14610 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14611 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14612 default value.
14613 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14614 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14615
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014616 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14617 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14618 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14619
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014620no-ssl-reuse
14621 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14622 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14623 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14624 and for paranoid users.
14625
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014626no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014627 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14628 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014629 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014630
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014631 Supported in default-server: No
14632
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014633no-tls-tickets
14634 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14635 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14636 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014637 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14638 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014639 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14640 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14641 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014642 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014643
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014644no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014645 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014646 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14647 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014648 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14649 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014650 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014651
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014652 Supported in default-server: No
14653
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014654no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014655 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014656 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14657 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014658 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14659 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014660 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014661
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014662 Supported in default-server: No
14663
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014664no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014665 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014666 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14667 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014668 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14669 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014670 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014671
14672 Supported in default-server: No
14673
14674no-tlsv13
14675 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14676 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14677 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14678 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14679 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014680 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014681
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014682 Supported in default-server: No
14683
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014684no-verifyhost
14685 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14686 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14687 default value.
14688 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14689 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014690
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014691no-tfo
14692 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14693 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14694 default value.
14695 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14696 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14697
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014698non-stick
14699 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14700 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14701 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14702
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014703npn <protocols>
14704 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14705 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14706 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014707 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014708 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14709 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14710 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14711
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014712observe <mode>
14713 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14714 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14715 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14716 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14717 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14718 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014719 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014720
14721 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14722
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014723on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014724 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14725 Currently, four modes are available:
14726 - fastinter: force fastinter
14727 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14728 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14729 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14730 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14731
14732 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14733
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014734on-marked-down <action>
14735 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14736 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014737 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14738 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14739 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14740 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14741 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14742 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14743 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14744 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014745
14746 Actions are disabled by default
14747
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014748on-marked-up <action>
14749 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14750 Currently one action is available:
14751 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14752 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14753 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14754 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014755 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14756 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014757 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14758 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14759
14760 Actions are disabled by default
14761
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014762pool-low-conn <max>
14763 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14764 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14765 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14766 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14767 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14768 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14769 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14770 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14771 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14772 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014773 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14774 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14775 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14776 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014777
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014778pool-max-conn <max>
14779 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14780 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14781 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14782 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14783 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14784 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14785
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014786pool-purge-delay <delay>
14787 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014788 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014789 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014791port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014792 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014793 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14794 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14795 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14796 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14797 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014798
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014799proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014800 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14801 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14802 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014803 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14804 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14805
14806 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14807 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14808 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14809 also reported (flag=HTX).
14810
14811 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14812 a server line :
14813
14814 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14815 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14816 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14817 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14818
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014819 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014820 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14821
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014822 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014824redir <prefix>
14825 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14826 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14827 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14828 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14829 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14830 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14831 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14832 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014833 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014834 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014835 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14836 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14837 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14838 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14839
14840 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014842rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014843 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14844 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14845 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14846
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014847resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14848 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14849 server.
14850
14851 Available options:
14852
14853 * allow-dup-ip
14854 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14855 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14856 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14857 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14858 For such case, simply enable this option.
14859 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14860
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014861 * ignore-weight
14862 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14863 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14864 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14865
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014866 * prevent-dup-ip
14867 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14868 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14869 same fqdn.
14870 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14871
14872 Example:
14873 backend b_myapp
14874 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14875 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14876 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14877
14878 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14879 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14880 it
14881 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14882 different address
14883
14884 Default value: not set
14885
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014886resolve-prefer <family>
14887 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14888 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14889 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14890 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14891
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014892 Default value: ipv6
14893
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014894 Example:
14895
14896 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014897
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014898resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014899 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014900 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014901 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014902 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14903 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014904 configured network, another address is selected.
14905
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014906 Example:
14907
14908 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014909
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014910resolvers <id>
14911 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14912 hostname.
14913
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014914 Example:
14915
14916 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014917
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014918 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014919
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014920send-proxy
14921 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14922 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14923 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14924 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014925 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14926 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14927 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14928 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014929 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014930 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14931 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14932 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14933 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14934 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014935 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14936 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014937
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014938send-proxy-v2
14939 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14940 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14941 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14942 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014943 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14944 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14945 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14946 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014947
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014948proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014949 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14950 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14951
14952 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14953 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14954 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14955 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14956 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14957 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14958 connection is supported).
14959 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14960 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14961 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14962 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14963 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14964 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14965 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014966
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014967send-proxy-v2-ssl
14968 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14969 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14970 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14971 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14972 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14973 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14974 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014975 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14976 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014977
14978send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14979 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14980 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14981 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14982 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14983 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14984 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14985 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14986 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014987 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14988 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014989
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014990slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014991 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14992 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14993 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14994 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14995 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14996 parameters :
14997
14998 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14999 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15000
15001 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15002 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15003 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15004 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15005
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015006 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015007 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15008 seen as failed.
15009
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015010sni <expression>
15011 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15012 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15013 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010015014 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
15015 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
15016 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
15017 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015018 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015019 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015020 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15021 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015022
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015023source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015024source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015025source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015026 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15027 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15028 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15029 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15030
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015031 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15032 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15033 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15034 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15035 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15036 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15037 server.
15038
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015039 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15040 specifying the source address without port(s).
15041
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015042ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015043 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15044 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15045 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15046 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15047 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15048 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015049 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15050 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015051
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015052ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15053 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15054 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15055 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15056
15057ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15058 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15059 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15060 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15061
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015062ssl-reuse
15063 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15064 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15065 default value.
15066 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15067 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15068
15069stick
15070 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15071 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15072 default value.
15073 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15074 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015075
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015076socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015077 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015078 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15079 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15080
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015081tcp-ut <delay>
15082 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015083 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015084 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015085 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015086 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15087 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15088 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15089 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15090 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15091 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15092 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15093 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15094 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15095
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015096tfo
15097 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15098 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15099 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15100 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015101 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015102 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015103
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015104track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015105 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15106 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15107 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15108 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015109 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15110
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015111tls-tickets
15112 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15113 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15114 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015115 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15116 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15117 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015118 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015119 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015120
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015121verify [none|required]
15122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015123 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015124 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15125 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015126 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015127 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15128 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15129 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15130 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15131 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15132 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15133 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15134 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015135
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015136verifyhost <hostname>
15137 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015138 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15139 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15140 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15141 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15142 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15143 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15144 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15145 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015146
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015147weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015148 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15149 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15150 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015151 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15152 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15153 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15154 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15155 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15156 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015157
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015158ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15159 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15160 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15161 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15162
15163 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15164 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15165 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15166 server ALPN contains it.
15167
15168 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15169 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15170 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15171 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15172
15173 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15174 favor of the ALPN extension.
15175
15176 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015178
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151795.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15180-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015181
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015182HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15183using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015184configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015185This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15186can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15187workload.
15188This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15189resolution at run time.
15190Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15191carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15192
15193
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151945.3.1. Global overview
15195----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015196
15197As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15198different steps of the process life:
15199
15200 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15201 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15202 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15203
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015204 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15205 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015206
15207A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15208 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15209 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15210 resolution to know this new IP.
15211
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015212When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015213HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015214SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15215from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015216will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015217will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015218
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015219A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015220 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015221 first valid response.
15222
15223 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15224 servers return an error.
15225
15226
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152275.3.2. The resolvers section
15228----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015229
15230This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015231HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15232contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015233
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015234When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15235uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15236is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15237answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15238
15239When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015240used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015241
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015242 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15243 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15244 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015245
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015246 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15247 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015248
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015249 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015250 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15251 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015252
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015253For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15254following scenarios are possible:
15255
15256 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15257 ignored
15258
15259 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15260 applied
15261
15262 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15263 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15264
15265 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15266 retries the query with a new type
15267
15268 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15269 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015270
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015271As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015272a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015273<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015274
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015275
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015276resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015277 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015278
15279A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15280
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015281accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015282 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015283 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015284 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15285 by RFC 6891)
15286
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015287 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15288 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15289 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15290 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15291 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15292 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015293
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015294nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15295 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15296 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15297 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15298 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15299 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15300 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15301 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15302 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15303 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015304 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15305
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015306parse-resolv-conf
15307 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15308 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15309 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15310
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015311hold <status> <period>
15312 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15313 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015314 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015315 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015316 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15317 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15318 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15319
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015320 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015321
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015322resolve_retries <nb>
15323 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15324 giving up.
15325 Default value: 3
15326
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015327 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15328 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15329 type.
15330
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015331timeout <event> <time>
15332 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15333 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15334 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015335 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15336 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015337 Default value: 1s
15338 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015339 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015340 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015341 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15342 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15343
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015344 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015345
15346 resolvers mydns
15347 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15348 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015349 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015350 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015351 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015352 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015353 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015354 hold other 30s
15355 hold refused 30s
15356 hold nx 30s
15357 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015358 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015359 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015360
15361
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153626. Cache
15363---------
15364
15365HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15366(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15367RAM.
15368
15369The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15370this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15371
15372If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15373independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15374when we try to allocate a new one.
15375
15376The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15377
15378It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15379"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15380for more details.
15381
15382When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15383replaced by "<CACHE>".
15384
15385
153866.1. Limitation
15387----------------
15388
15389The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15390
15391- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015392- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15393 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15394 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015395- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15396- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015397- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15398 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15399 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015400- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15401 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015402- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15403 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15404 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015405
15406- If the request is not a GET
15407- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15408- If the request contains an Authorization header
15409
15410
154116.2. Setup
15412-----------
15413
15414To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15415the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15416
15417
154186.2.1. Cache section
15419---------------------
15420
15421cache <name>
15422 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15423 size of cache is mandatory.
15424
15425total-max-size <megabytes>
15426 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15427 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15428
15429max-object-size <bytes>
15430 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15431 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15432 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15433
15434max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015435 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015436 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15437 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15438 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15439 default.
15440
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015441process-vary <on/off>
15442 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015443 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15444 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15445 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015446 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015447
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015448max-secondary-entries <number>
15449 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15450 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15451 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15452
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015453
154546.2.2. Proxy section
15455---------------------
15456
15457http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15458 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15459 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15460 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15461 after this one.
15462
15463http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15464 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15465 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15466 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15467 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15468
15469
15470Example:
15471
15472 backend bck1
15473 mode http
15474
15475 http-request cache-use foobar
15476 http-response cache-store foobar
15477 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15478
15479 cache foobar
15480 total-max-size 4
15481 max-age 240
15482
15483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154847. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15485----------------------------------
15486
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015487HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15489The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15490these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15491but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15492data called patterns.
15493
15494
154957.1. ACL basics
15496---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015497
15498The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15499content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15500from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15501simple :
15502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015503 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015504 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015505 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15506 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15509adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015510
15511In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015513 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015514
15515This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15516Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15517and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015518an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15519conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15520as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15521are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015522
15523ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15524'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15525which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15526
15527There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15528performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015530The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15531specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15532this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015533methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15534ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015535
15536Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15537 - boolean
15538 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15539 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15540 - string
15541 - data block
15542
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015543Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15544converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15545would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15546The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15547which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15548
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015549Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15550keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15551fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15552which are summarized in the table below :
15553
15554 +---------------------+-----------------+
15555 | Sample or converter | Default |
15556 | output type | matching method |
15557 +---------------------+-----------------+
15558 | boolean | bool |
15559 +---------------------+-----------------+
15560 | integer | int |
15561 +---------------------+-----------------+
15562 | ip | ip |
15563 +---------------------+-----------------+
15564 | string | str |
15565 +---------------------+-----------------+
15566 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15567 +---------------------+-----------------+
15568
15569Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15570matching method, see below.
15571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15573 - boolean
15574 - integer or integer range
15575 - IP address / network
15576 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15577 - regular expression
15578 - hex block
15579
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015580The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15581
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015582 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15583 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015584 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015585 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015586 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015587 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015588 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015590The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15591read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15592if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15593lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15594will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15595beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015596a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015597lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15598exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15599
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015600The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15601parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15602ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15603a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15604check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15605
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015606The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15607socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15608file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15611loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15612
15613 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15614
15615In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15616the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15617case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15618as well.
15619
15620The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15621sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15622do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15623methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15624is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015625obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015626followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15627default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15628that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15629string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15630
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015631The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15632By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15633string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15634resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015635server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015636waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015637flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15638function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015640There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15641sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15642be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015643
15644 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15645 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015646 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15647 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15648 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15649 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015650
15651 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15652 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015654
15655 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015656 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015657
15658 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015660
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015661 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015662 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15663
15664 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15665 binary or string samples.
15666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15668 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15671 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15672 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015674 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15675 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15678 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15681 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015683 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15684 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015685 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15688 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15689 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015690
15691For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15692request, it is possible to do :
15693
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015694 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015695
15696In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15697buffer, one would use the following acl :
15698
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015699 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015700
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015701On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15702possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15703
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015704 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015706All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15707criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15708method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15709to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15710criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15711the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015714the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15715For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15718 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15719 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15720 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015721
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015722
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015723The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15724types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15725combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15726brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15727default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729 +-------------------------------------------------+
15730 | Input sample type |
15731 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015732 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015733 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15734 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15735 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015736 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015738 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015739 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015740 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015742 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015743 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015744 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015745 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015746 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015748 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015749 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015750 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015752 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015753 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015754 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015755 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015756 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15758 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15759 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015760
15761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157627.1.1. Matching booleans
15763------------------------
15764
15765In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15766Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15767When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15768that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15769
15770Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15771return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15772"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15773
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157757.1.2. Matching integers
15776------------------------
15777
15778Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15779enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15780to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15781
15782Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15783matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15784lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015785
15786For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15787unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15788representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15789
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015790As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15791two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15792instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15793ranges and operators.
15794
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015795For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015796operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15797Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15798of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015799
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015800Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015801
15802 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15803 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15804 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15805 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15806 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015808For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015809
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015810 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015811
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015812This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15813
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015814 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015815
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158177.1.3. Matching strings
15818-----------------------
15819
15820String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15821different forms :
15822
15823 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015824 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015825
15826 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015827 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015828
15829 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15830 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15831
15832 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15833 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15834
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015835 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015836 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15837 matches.
15838
15839 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15840 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15841 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015842
15843String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15844exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15845characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15846string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15847to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015848before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015849
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015850Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15851(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15852Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15853
15854Example:
15855 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15856 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15857
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158597.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15860---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015861
15862Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15863they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15864possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15865passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15866the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015867the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15868match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015869
15870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158717.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15872-------------------------------------
15873
15874It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15875not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15876a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15877to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15878digits may be used upper or lower case.
15879
15880Example :
15881 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015882 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015883
15884
158857.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15886---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015887
15888IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15889netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15890within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015891host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015892difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15893at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15894does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15895parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015896
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015897The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15898abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15899
15900 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15901 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15902 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15903 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15904 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15905 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15906 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15907 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15908
15909Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15910192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15911
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015912IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15913Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15914trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15915IPv6 patterns.
15916
15917HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15918following situations :
15919 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15920 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15921 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15922 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15923 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15924 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15925 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15926 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15927 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15928 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015930
159317.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15932----------------------------------
15933
15934Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15935combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15936
15937 - AND (implicit)
15938 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15939 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015941A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015943 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015945Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15946indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15949"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15950requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15951is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15952
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015953 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015954 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15955 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15956 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957
15958To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15959and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15960
15961 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15962 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15963 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15964 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15965
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015966 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015967 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15968 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15969 use_backend www if host_www
15970
15971It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15972expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15973be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15974the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15975
15976 The following rule :
15977
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015978 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015979 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015980
15981 Can also be written that way :
15982
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015983 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984
15985It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15986to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15987simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15988sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15989good use is the following :
15990
15991 With named ACLs :
15992
15993 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15994 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15995 monitor fail if site_dead
15996
15997 With anonymous ACLs :
15998
15999 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16000
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016001See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16002keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003
16004
160057.3. Fetching samples
16006---------------------
16007
16008Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16009against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16010sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16011ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16012of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16013available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16014
16015This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16016Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16017compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16018deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16019
16020The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16021matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16022method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16023indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16024
16025As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16026when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16027mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16028the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16029ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16030
16031Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16032multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16033when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016034incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16035are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016036is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16037all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16038
16039Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16040 - name
16041 - name(arg1)
16042 - name(arg1,arg2)
16043
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016044
160457.3.1. Converters
16046-----------------
16047
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016048Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16049of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16050is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16051was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016052has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016053unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16054
16055These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16056sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16057the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016058support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016059
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016060A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16061support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16062supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16063(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16064bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016066The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016067
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001606851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16069 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16070 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16071 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16072 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16073 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16074
16075 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016076 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16077 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016078 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16079 frontend http-in
16080 bind *:8081
16081 default_backend servers
16082 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16083 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16084
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016085add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016086 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016087 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016088 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16089 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016090 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016091 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16092 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16093 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16094 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016095 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016096 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016097
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016098aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16099 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16100 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16101 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16102 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16103 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16104 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16105
16106 Example:
16107 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16108 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16109
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016110and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016111 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016112 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016113 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16114 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016115 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016116 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16117 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16118 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16119 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016120 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016121 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016122
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016123b64dec
16124 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16125 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016126 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16127 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016128
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016129base64
16130 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016131 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016132 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16133 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016134
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016135bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016136 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016137 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016138 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016139 presence of a flag).
16140
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016141bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16142 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16143 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016144 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016145
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016146concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16147 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16148 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16149 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16150 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16151 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16152 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16153 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16154 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16155 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16156 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016157 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016158 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016159 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16160 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016161
16162 Example:
16163 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16164 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16165 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016166 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016167 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16168
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016169cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016170 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16171 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016172
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016173crc32([<avalanche>])
16174 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16175 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16176 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16177 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16178 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16179 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16180 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16181 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16182 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16183 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016184 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16185
16186crc32c([<avalanche>])
16187 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16188 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16189 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16190 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16191 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16192 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16193 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16194 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016195
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016196cut_crlf
16197 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16198 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16199 updated.
16200
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016201da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016202 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16203 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16204 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16205 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016206 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016207 configuration language.
16208
16209 Example:
16210 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016211 bind *:8881
16212 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016213 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016214
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016215debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16216 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16217 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16218 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16219 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16220 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16221 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16222 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16223 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16224 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16225 printable sample types.
16226
16227 Example:
16228 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016229
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016230digest(<algorithm>)
16231 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16232 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16233
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016234 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016235 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16236
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016237div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016238 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16239 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016240 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016241 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16242 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016243 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016244 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16245 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16246 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16247 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016248 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016249 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016250
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016251djb2([<avalanche>])
16252 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16253 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16254 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16255 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16256 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16257 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16258 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016259 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16260 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016261
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016262even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016263 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016264 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16265
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016266field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16267 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16268 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16269 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16270 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16271 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16272 fields.
16273
16274 Example :
16275 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16276 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16277 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16278 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16279 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016280
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016281fix_is_valid
16282 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16283 Information eXchange):
16284
16285 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16286 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016287 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016288 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016289 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016290 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16291 checksum
16292
16293 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16294 the server can be parsed.
16295
16296 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16297 message, false if not.
16298
16299 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16300
16301 Example:
16302 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16303 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16304
16305fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16306 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16307 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16308 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16309 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016310 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016311 added.
16312
16313 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16314 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16315 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16316 fix_is_valid converter.
16317
16318 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16319
16320 Example:
16321 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16322 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16323 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16324 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16325 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16326
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016327hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016328 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016329 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016330 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016331 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016332
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016333hex2i
16334 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016335 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016336
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016337htonl
16338 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16339 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16340 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16341 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16342
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016343hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016344 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16345 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16346 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16347 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16348
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016349 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016350 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16351
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016352http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016353 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16354 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016355 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16356 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16357 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16358 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16359 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16360 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16361 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16362 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016363
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016364iif(<true>,<false>)
16365 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16366 string otherwise.
16367
16368 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016369 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016370
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016371in_table(<table>)
16372 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16373 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16374 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016375 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016376 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16377
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016378ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016379 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016380 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016381 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16382 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16383 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16384 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16385 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016386
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016387json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016388 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016389 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016390 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016391 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16392 of errors:
16393 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16394 bytes, ...)
16395 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16396 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16397
16398 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16399 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16400 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16401 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16402 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16403 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016404 - "ascii" : never fails;
16405 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16406 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016407 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016408 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016409 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16410 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16411
16412 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016413 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016414
16415 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016416 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016417 capture request header user-agent len 150
16418 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016419
16420 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16421 GET / HTTP/1.0
16422 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16423
16424 Output log:
16425 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16426
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016427json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16428 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16429 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16430 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16431 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16432
16433 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16434 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16435
16436 Example:
16437 # get a integer value from the request body
16438 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16439 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16440
16441 # get a key with '.' in the name
16442 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16443 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16444
16445 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16446 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16447
16448 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16449 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16450
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016451language(<value>[,<default>])
16452 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16453 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16454 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16455 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16456 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16457 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16458 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16459 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16460 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016461 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016462 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16463 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016464
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016465 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016466
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016467 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16468 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016469
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016470 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16471 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16472 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16473 use_backend spanish if es
16474 use_backend french if fr
16475 use_backend english if en
16476 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016477
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016478length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016479 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16480 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16481 type. The result is of type integer.
16482
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016483lower
16484 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16485 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16486 type. The result is of type string.
16487
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016488ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16489 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16490 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16491 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16492 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16493 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16494 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16495
16496 Example :
16497
16498 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016499 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016500 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16501
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016502ltrim(<chars>)
16503 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16504 representation of the input sample.
16505
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016506map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16507map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16508map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16509 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16510 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16511 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16512 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16513 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16514 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16515 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16516 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016517
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016518 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16519 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16520 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016521
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016522 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016523 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016524
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016525 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16526 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16527 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16528 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016529 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16530 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016531 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16532 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16533 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16534 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16535 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16536 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16537 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16538 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016539 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16540 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16541 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016542 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16543 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16544 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16545 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16546 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016547
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016548 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16549 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16550 the corresponding match text.
16551
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016552 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16553 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16554 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16555 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16556 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016557
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016558 Example :
16559
16560 # this is a comment and is ignored
16561 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16562 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16563 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16564 | | | `---------- value
16565 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16566 | `---------------------------- key
16567 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16568
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016569mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016570 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16571 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016572 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016573 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016574 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016575 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16576 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16577 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16578 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016579 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016580 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016581
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016582mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016583 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16584 <packettype>.
16585 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16586 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16587 from.
16588 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16589 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16590 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16591
16592 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16593 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16594 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16595 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16596
16597 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16598 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16599 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16600 packets only):
16601 17: Session Expiry Interval
16602 33: Receive Maximum
16603 39: Maximum Packet Size
16604 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16605 25: Request Response Information
16606 23: Request Problem Information
16607 21: Authentication Method
16608 22: Authentication Data
16609 18: Will Delay Interval
16610 1: Payload Format Indicator
16611 2: Message Expiry Interval
16612 3: Content Type
16613 8: Response Topic
16614 9: Correlation Data
16615 Not supported yet:
16616 38: User Property
16617
16618 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16619 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16620 packets only):
16621 17: Session Expiry Interval
16622 33: Receive Maximum
16623 36: Maximum QoS
16624 37: Retain Available
16625 39: Maximum Packet Size
16626 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16627 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16628 31: Reason String
16629 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16630 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16631 42: Shared Subscription Available
16632 19: Server Keep Alive
16633 26: Response Information
16634 28: Server Reference
16635 21: Authentication Method
16636 22: Authentication Data
16637 Not supported yet:
16638 38: User Property
16639
16640 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16641 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16642 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16643 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16644
16645 Example:
16646
16647 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16648 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16649 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16650 if data_in_buffer
16651 # do the same as above
16652 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16653 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16654 if data_in_buffer
16655
16656mqtt_is_valid
16657 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16658
16659 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16660 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16661 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16662 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16663
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016664 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16665
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016666 Example:
16667
16668 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016669 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016670
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016671mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016672 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016673 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16674 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016675 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016676 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016677 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016678 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16679 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16680 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16681 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016682 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016683 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016684
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016685nbsrv
16686 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16687 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16688 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16689 map lookup.
16690
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016691neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016692 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16693 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16694 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16695 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016696
16697not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016698 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016699 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016700 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016701 absence of a flag).
16702
16703odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016704 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016705 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16706
16707or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016708 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016709 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016710 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16711 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016712 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016713 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16714 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16715 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16716 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016717 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016718 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016719
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016720protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16721 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16722 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16723 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16724 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16725 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16726 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16727 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16728 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16729 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16730 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16731 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16732
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016733regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016734 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16735 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16736 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16737 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16738 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16739 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16740 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16741 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16742 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016743 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16744 of characters with other ones.
16745
16746 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16747 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16748 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16749 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16750 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16751 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016752
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016753 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016754
16755 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16756 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16757 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016758 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016759
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016760 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16761 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16762
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016763 # capture groups and backreferences
16764 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016765 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016766 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16767
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016768capture-req(<id>)
16769 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16770 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16771
16772 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016773 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16774 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016775
16776capture-res(<id>)
16777 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16778 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16779
16780 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016781 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16782 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016783
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016784rtrim(<chars>)
16785 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16786 of the input sample.
16787
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016788sdbm([<avalanche>])
16789 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16790 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16791 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16792 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16793 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16794 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16795 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016796 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16797 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016798
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016799secure_memcmp(<var>)
16800 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16801 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16802 match.
16803
16804 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16805 performed in constant time.
16806
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016807 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016808 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16809
16810 Example :
16811
16812 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16813 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16814 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16815 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16816
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016817set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016818 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16819 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16820 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016821 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016822 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16823 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016824 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016825 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16826 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016827 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016828 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016829
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016830sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016831 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016832 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16833
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016834sha2([<bits>])
16835 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16836 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16837
16838 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16839 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16840
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016841 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016842 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16843
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016844srv_queue
16845 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16846 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16847 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16848 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16849 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16850
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016851strcmp(<var>)
16852 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16853 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16854 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16855 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16856 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16857 shorter).
16858
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016859 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16860 strings in constant time.
16861
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016862 Example :
16863
16864 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16865 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16866 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16867
16868
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016869sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016870 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16871 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016872 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016873 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16874 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016875 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016876 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16877 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016878 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016879 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16880 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016881 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016882 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016883
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016884table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16885 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16886 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16887 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16888 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16889 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16890 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16891
16892
16893table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16894 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16895 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16896 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16897 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16898 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16899 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16900
16901table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16902 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16903 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016904 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016905 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16906 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16907
16908table_conn_cur(<table>)
16909 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16910 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16911 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16912 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16913 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16914
16915table_conn_rate(<table>)
16916 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16917 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16918 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16919 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16920 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16921
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016922table_gpt0(<table>)
16923 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16924 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16925 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16926 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16927 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16928
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016929table_gpc0(<table>)
16930 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16931 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16932 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16933 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16934 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16935
16936table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16937 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16938 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16939 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16940 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16941 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16942 sample fetch keyword.
16943
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016944table_gpc1(<table>)
16945 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16946 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16947 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16948 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16949 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16950
16951table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16952 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16953 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16954 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16955 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16956 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16957 sample fetch keyword.
16958
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016959table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16960 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16961 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016962 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016963 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16964 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16965
16966table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16967 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16968 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16969 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16970 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16971 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16972 keyword.
16973
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016974table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16975 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16976 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16977 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16978 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16979 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16980
16981table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16982 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16983 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16984 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16985 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16986 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16987 keyword.
16988
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016989table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16990 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16991 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016992 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016993 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16994 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16995
16996table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16997 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16998 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16999 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17000 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17001 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17002 keyword.
17003
17004table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17005 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17006 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017007 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017008 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17009 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17010 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17011 keyword.
17012
17013table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17014 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17015 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017016 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017017 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17018 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17019 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17020 keyword.
17021
17022table_server_id(<table>)
17023 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17024 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17025 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17026 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17027 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17028 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17029
17030table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17031 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17032 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017033 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017034 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17035 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17036 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17037 keyword.
17038
17039table_sess_rate(<table>)
17040 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17041 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17042 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17043 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17044 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17045 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17046 keyword.
17047
17048table_trackers(<table>)
17049 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17050 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17051 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17052 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17053 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17054 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17055 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17056 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17057 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17058 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17059
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017060ub64dec
17061 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17062 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17063 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17064
17065 Example:
17066 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17067 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17068
17069ub64enc
17070 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17071
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017072upper
17073 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17074 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17075 type. The result is of type string.
17076
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017077url_dec([<in_form>])
17078 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17079 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17080 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17081 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17082 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17083 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017084
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017085url_enc([<enc_type>])
17086 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17087 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17088 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17089 optional argument is here for future changes.
17090
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017091ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017092 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017093 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17094 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17095 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017096 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17097 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17098 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17099 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017100 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017101 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17102 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017103
17104 Example:
17105 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17106 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17107
17108 message Point {
17109 int32 latitude = 1;
17110 int32 longitude = 2;
17111 }
17112
17113 message PPoint {
17114 Point point = 59;
17115 }
17116
17117 message Rectangle {
17118 // One corner of the rectangle.
17119 PPoint lo = 48;
17120 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17121 PPoint hi = 49;
17122 }
17123
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017124 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17125 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17126 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017127
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017128 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17129 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017130 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017131 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17132
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017133 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017134
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017135 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017136
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017137 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17138 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17139 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017140
17141 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17142 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17143 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17144
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017145 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17146 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17147 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017148
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017149
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017150unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017151 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17152 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17153 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17154 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17155 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17156 response),
17157 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17158 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17159 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17160 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17161
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017162utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17163 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17164 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17165 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17166 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17167 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17168 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17169
17170 Example :
17171
17172 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017173 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017174 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17175
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017176word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17177 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17178 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17179 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017180 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017181 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17182 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17183
17184 Example :
17185 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17186 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17187 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17188 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17189 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017190 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017191
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017192wt6([<avalanche>])
17193 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17194 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17195 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17196 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17197 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17198 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17199 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017200 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17201 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017202
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017203xor(<value>)
17204 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017205 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017206 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017207 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017208 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017209 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17210 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017211 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017212 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17213 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017214 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017215 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017216
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017217xxh3([<seed>])
17218 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17219 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17220 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17221 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17222 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17223 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17224 considered as cryptographically secure.
17225
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017226xxh32([<seed>])
17227 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17228 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17229 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17230 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17231 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17232 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17233 as cryptographically secure.
17234
17235xxh64([<seed>])
17236 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17237 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17238 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17239 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17240 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17241 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17242 as cryptographically secure.
17243
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017244
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172457.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017246--------------------------------------------
17247
17248A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17249not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17250"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17251The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17252
17253always_false : boolean
17254 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17255 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17256
17257always_true : boolean
17258 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17259 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17260
17261avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017262 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017263 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17264 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17265 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17266 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17267 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17268 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17269 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17270 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17271 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17272 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17273 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17274 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17275 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017277be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017278 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17279 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17280 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17281 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017282 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17283
17284be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17285 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17286 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17287 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17288 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17289 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017290 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17291 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017292
17293 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17294 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17295 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017297be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17298 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17299 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17300 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017301 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017302 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17303 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017304
17305 Example :
17306 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17307 backend dynamic
17308 mode http
17309 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17310 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017311
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017312bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017313 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17314 of the string.
17315
17316bool(<bool>) : bool
17317 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17318 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017320connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17321 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017322 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017323 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17324 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017325
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017326 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017327 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017328 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17329
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017330 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17331 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017332
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017333 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017334 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017335 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017336 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017337 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017338 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017339 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017340
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017341 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17342 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017343 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017344 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017345
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017346cpu_calls : integer
17347 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17348 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17349 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17350 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17351 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17352 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17353
17354cpu_ns_avg : integer
17355 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17356 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17357 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17358 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17359 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17360 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17361 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17362 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17363 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17364 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17365 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17366
17367cpu_ns_tot : integer
17368 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17369 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17370 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17371 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17372 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17373 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17374 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17375 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17376 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17377 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17378 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17379 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17380 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17381
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017382date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017383 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017384
17385 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17386 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17387 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017388 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17389
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017390 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17391 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17392 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17393 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17394 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17395
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017396 Example :
17397
17398 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17399 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017400
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017401 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17402 # millisecond granularity
17403 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17404
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017405date_us : integer
17406 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17407 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17408 from the same timeval structure.
17409
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017410distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17411 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17412 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17413 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17414 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017415 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017416 list of supported tokens.
17417
17418distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17419 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17420 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17421 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17422 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017423 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017424 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17425 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17426 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17427 supported tokens.
17428
17429 Example :
17430 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17431 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17432 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17433 # send large files to the big farm
17434 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17435
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017436env(<name>) : string
17437 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17438 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17439 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17440 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17441 certain way.
17442
17443 Examples :
17444 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17445 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17446
17447 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017448 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017450fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17451 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017452 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17453 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017454 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17455 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017456 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017457 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17458 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017459
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017460fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17461 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17462 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17463 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017465fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17466 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17467 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17468 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17469 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17470 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17471 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17472 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17473 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017474
17475 Example :
17476 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17477 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17478 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17479 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17480 frontend mail
17481 bind :25
17482 mode tcp
17483 maxconn 100
17484 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17485 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17486 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17487 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017488
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017489hostname : string
17490 Returns the system hostname.
17491
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017492int(<integer>) : signed integer
17493 Returns a signed integer.
17494
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017495ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17496 Returns an ipv4.
17497
17498ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17499 Returns an ipv6.
17500
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017501lat_ns_avg : integer
17502 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17503 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17504 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17505 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17506 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17507 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17508 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17509 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17510 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017511 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17512 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17513 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17514 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17515 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17516 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017517
17518lat_ns_tot : integer
17519 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17520 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17521 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17522 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17523 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17524 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17525 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17526 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17527 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017528 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17529 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17530 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17531 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17532 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017533 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17534 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17535 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17536 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17537 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17538 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17539
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017540meth(<method>) : method
17541 Returns a method.
17542
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017543nbproc : integer
17544 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17545 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17546 and debugging purposes.
17547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017548nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17549 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17550 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17551 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017552 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17553 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17554 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017555
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017556prio_class : integer
17557 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17558 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17559 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17560
17561prio_offset : integer
17562 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17563 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17564 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17565 set-priority-offset".
17566
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017567proc : integer
17568 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17569 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17570 debugging purposes.
17571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017572queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017573 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17574 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17575 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017576 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17577 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17578 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17579 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17580 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17581
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017582rand([<range>]) : integer
17583 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17584 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17585 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17586 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17587 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017589srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17590 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17591 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17592 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17593 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17594 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017595 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17596 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17597
17598srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17599 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17600 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17601 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17602 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17603 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17604 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17605 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17606
17607 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17608 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017609
17610srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17611 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17612 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17613 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017614 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017615 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17616 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17617 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17618
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017619srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17620 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17621 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17622 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17623 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17624 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17625 fetch methods.
17626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017627srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17628 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17629 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017630 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017631 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17632 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017633 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017634 overloading servers).
17635
17636 Example :
17637 # Redirect to a separate back
17638 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17639 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17640 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17641
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017642srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017643 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17644 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17645 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17646
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017647srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017648 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17649 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17650 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17651
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017652srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017653 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17654 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17655 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17656
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017657stopping : boolean
17658 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17659 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17660 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17661
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017662str(<string>) : string
17663 Returns a string.
17664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017665table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17666 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17667 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17668
17669table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17670 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17671 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17672 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17673
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017674thread : integer
17675 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17676 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17677 and debugging purposes.
17678
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017679uuid([<version>]) : string
17680 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17681 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17682 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17683
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017684var(<var-name>) : undefined
17685 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017686 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17687 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017688 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017689 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17690 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017691 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017692 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17693 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017694 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017695 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017696
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176977.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017698----------------------------------
17699
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017700The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017701closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17702methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17703sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17704TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017705the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17706counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017707"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17708used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17709can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17710Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17711table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17712tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17713currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017714
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017715bc_dst : ip
17716 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17717 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17718 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17719 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17720
17721bc_dst_port : integer
17722 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017723 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017724
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017725bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017726 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17727 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17728 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17729
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017730bc_src : ip
17731 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017732 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017733 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17734 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17735
17736bc_src_port : integer
17737 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017738 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017740be_id : integer
17741 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017742 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17743 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017744
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017745be_name : string
17746 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017747 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17748 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017749
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017750be_server_timeout : integer
17751 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17752 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17753 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17754
17755be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17756 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17757 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17758 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17759
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017760cur_server_timeout : integer
17761 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17762 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17763 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17764
17765cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17766 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17767 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17768 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017770dst : ip
17771 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17772 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17773 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17774 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017775 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17776 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17777 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17778 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17779 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17780 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017781
17782dst_conn : integer
17783 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17784 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17785 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17786 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17787 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17788 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17789 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17790 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017791
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017792dst_is_local : boolean
17793 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17794 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17795 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17796 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017797 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017798 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17799 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17800 it only once per connection.
17801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017802dst_port : integer
17803 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17804 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17805 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17806 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17807 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17808 an HTTP header.
17809
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017810fc_fackets : integer
17811 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17812 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17813 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17814 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17815
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017816fc_http_major : integer
17817 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17818 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17819 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17820
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017821fc_lost : integer
17822 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17823 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17824 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17825 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17826
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017827fc_pp_authority : string
17828 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17829 if any.
17830
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017831fc_pp_unique_id : string
17832 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17833 if any.
17834
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017835fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17836 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17837 header.
17838
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017839fc_reordering : integer
17840 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17841 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17842 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17843 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17844
17845fc_retrans : integer
17846 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17847 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17848 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17849 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17850
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017851fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17852 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17853 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17854 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17855 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17856 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17857 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17858
17859fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17860 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17861 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17862 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17863 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17864 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17865 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17866
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017867fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017868 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17869 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17870 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17871 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17872
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017873
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017874fc_unacked : integer
17875 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17876 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17877 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17878 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017879
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017880fe_defbe : string
17881 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17882 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017884fe_id : integer
17885 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017886 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017887 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17888
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017889fe_name : string
17890 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17891 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17892 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17893
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017894fe_client_timeout : integer
17895 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17896 current frontend.
17897
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017898sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017899sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17900sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17901sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017902 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17903 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17904 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17905
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017906sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017907sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17908sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17909sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017910 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17911 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17912 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17913
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017914sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017915sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17916sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17917sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017918 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17919 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017920 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17921 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17922 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017923
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017924 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017925 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17926 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017927 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17928 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17929 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017930 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17931 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17932
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017933sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17934sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17935sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17936sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17937 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17938 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17939 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17940 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17941 when a first ACL was verified.
17942
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017943sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017944sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17945sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17946sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017947 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017948 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17949
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017950sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017951sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17952sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17953sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017954 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17955 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17956 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17957
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017958sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017959sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17960sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17961sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017962 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17963 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17964 See also src_conn_rate.
17965
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017966sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017967sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17968sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17969sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017970 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017971 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017972
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017973sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17974sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17975sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17976sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17977 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17978 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17979
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017980sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17981sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17982sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17983sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17984 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17985 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17986
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017987sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017988sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17989sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17990sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017991 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17992 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17993 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017994 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17995 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17996 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017997
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017998sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17999sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18000sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18001sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18002 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18003 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18004 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18005 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18006 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18007 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18008
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018009sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018010sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18011sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18012sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018013 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018014 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18015 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18016
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018017sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018018sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18019sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18020sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018021 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18022 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18023 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18024 src_http_err_rate.
18025
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018026sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18027sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18028sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18029sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18030 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18031 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18032 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18033
18034sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18035sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18036sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18037sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18038 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18039 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18040 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18041 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18042
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018043sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018044sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18045sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18046sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018047 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018048 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18049 src_http_req_cnt.
18050
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018051sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018052sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18053sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18054sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018055 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18056 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18057 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18058 src_http_req_rate.
18059
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018060sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018061sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18062sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18063sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018064 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018065 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18066 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18067 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18068 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018069
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018070 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018071 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18072 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018073 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18074
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018075sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18076sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18077sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18078sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18079 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18080 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18081 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18082 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18083 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18084
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018085sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018086sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18087sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18088sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018089 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18090 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18091 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018092
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018093sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018094sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18095sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18096sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018097 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18098 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18099 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018100
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018101sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018102sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18103sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18104sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018105 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018106 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18107 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18108 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018109 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018110 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18111
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018112sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018113sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18114sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18115sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018116 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18117 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18118 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18119 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18120 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018121 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018122
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018123sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018124sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18125sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18126sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018127 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18128 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18129 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18130
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018131sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018132sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18133sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18134sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018135 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18136 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018137 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018138 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18139 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018140 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18141 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18142 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018144so_id : integer
18145 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18146 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18147 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018148
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018149so_name : string
18150 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18151 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18152 strings instead of integers.
18153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018154src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018155 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018156 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18157 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18158 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018159 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18160 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18161 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018162 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18163 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18164 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18165 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18166 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18167 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18168 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018169
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018170 Example:
18171 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18172 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018174src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18175 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18176 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18177 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018178 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018180src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18181 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18182 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018183 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018184 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018186src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18187 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18188 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18189 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18190 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18191 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18192 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018193
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018194 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018195 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18196 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18197 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18198 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018199 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018200 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18201 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18202
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018203src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18204 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18205 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18206 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18207 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18208 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18209 was verified.
18210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018211src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018212 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018213 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018214 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018215 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018217src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018218 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018219 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18220 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018221 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018223src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18224 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18225 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18226 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018227 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018229src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018230 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018231 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018232 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018233 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018234
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018235src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18236 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18237 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18238 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18239 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18240
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018241src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18242 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18243 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18244 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18245 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018247src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018248 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018249 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018250 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18251 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018252 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18253 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18254 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018255
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018256src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18257 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18258 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18259 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18260 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18261 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18262 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18263 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018265src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018266 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018267 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018268 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018269 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018270 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018272src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18273 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18274 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18275 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18276 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018277 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018278
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018279src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18280 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18281 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018282 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018283 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18284 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18285
18286src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18287 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18288 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18289 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18290 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18291 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18292 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018294src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018295 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018296 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18297 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018298 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018300src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18301 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18302 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18303 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018304 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018305 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018307src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18308 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18309 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18310 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018311 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018312 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18313 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018314
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018315 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018316 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018317 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018318 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018319
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018320src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18321 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18322 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18323 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18324 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18325 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18326 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18327
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018328src_is_local : boolean
18329 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18330 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18331 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18332 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018333 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018334 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18335 once per connection.
18336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018337src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018338 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18339 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18340 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18341 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18342 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018344src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018345 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18346 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18347 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18348 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18349 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018351src_port : integer
18352 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18353 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18354 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18355 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018357src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018358 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018359 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18360 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18361 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018362 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018364src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18365 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18366 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18367 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18368 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018369 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018371src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18372 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18373 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18374 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18375 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18376 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18377 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18378 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18379 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018380
18381 Example :
18382 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18383 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18384 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18385 listen ssh
18386 bind :22
18387 mode tcp
18388 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018389 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018390 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018391 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018393srv_id : integer
18394 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18395 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018396 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018397
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018398srv_name : string
18399 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18400 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018401 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018402
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200184037.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018404----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018405
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018406The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018407closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18408when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18409usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018410future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018411
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001841251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18413 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18414 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18415 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18416 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18417 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18418
18419 Example :
18420 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18421 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18422 # the request.
18423 frontend http-in
18424 bind *:8081
18425 default_backend servers
18426 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18427 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18428
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018429ssl_bc : boolean
18430 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18431 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018432 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18433 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018434
18435ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18436 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018437 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18438 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018439
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018440ssl_bc_alpn : string
18441 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18442 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018443 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018444 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18445 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18446 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18447 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18448 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018449 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18450 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018451
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018452ssl_bc_cipher : string
18453 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018454 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18455 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018456
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018457ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18458 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18459 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18460 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018461 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018462
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018463ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18464 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18465 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018466 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18467 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018468
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018469ssl_bc_npn : string
18470 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18471 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018472 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018473 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18474 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18475 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18476 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018477 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18478 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018479
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018480ssl_bc_protocol : string
18481 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018482 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18483 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018484
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018485ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018486 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018487 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018488 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18489 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018490
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018491ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18492 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18493 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18494 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018495 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018496
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018497ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18498 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18499 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018500 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18501 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018502
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018503ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18504 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18505 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18506 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018507 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018508
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018509ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18510 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018511 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18512 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018514ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18515 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18516 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18517 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18518 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18519 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018521ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18522 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18523 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18524 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18525 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018526
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018527ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018528 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18529 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18530 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018531 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018532 does not support resumed sessions.
18533
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018534ssl_c_der : binary
18535 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18536 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18537 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018539ssl_c_err : integer
18540 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18541 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18542 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18543 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18544 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018545
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018546ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018547 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18548 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18549 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18550 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18551 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18552 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18553 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18554 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018555 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18556 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18557 LDAP v3.
18558 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18559 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018561ssl_c_key_alg : string
18562 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18563 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18564 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018566ssl_c_notafter : string
18567 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18568 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18569 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018571ssl_c_notbefore : string
18572 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18573 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18574 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018575
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018576ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018577 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18578 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18579 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18580 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18581 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18582 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18583 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18584 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018585 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18586 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18587 LDAP v3.
18588 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18589 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018591ssl_c_serial : binary
18592 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18593 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18594 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018596ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18597 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18598 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18599 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018600 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18601 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18602
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018603 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018604 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018606ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18607 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18608 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18609 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018611ssl_c_used : boolean
18612 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18613 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018615ssl_c_verify : integer
18616 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18617 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18618 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18619 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018621ssl_c_version : integer
18622 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18623 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018624
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018625ssl_f_der : binary
18626 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18627 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18628 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18629
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018630ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018631 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18632 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18633 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18634 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018635 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018636 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18637 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18638 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018639 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18640 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18641 LDAP v3.
18642 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18643 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018645ssl_f_key_alg : string
18646 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18647 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18648 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018650ssl_f_notafter : string
18651 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18652 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18653 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018655ssl_f_notbefore : string
18656 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18657 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18658 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018659
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018660ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018661 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18662 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18663 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18664 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18665 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18666 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18667 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18668 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018669 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18670 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18671 LDAP v3.
18672 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18673 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018675ssl_f_serial : binary
18676 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18677 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18678 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018679
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018680ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18681 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18682 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18683 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018685ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18686 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18687 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18688 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018690ssl_f_version : integer
18691 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18692 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18693
18694ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018695 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18696 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18697 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018699 Example :
18700 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18701 listen http-https
18702 bind :80
18703 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18704 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18705
18706ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18707 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18708 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18709
18710ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018711 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018712 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018713 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018714 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18715 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18716 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18717 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18718 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18719 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018721ssl_fc_cipher : string
18722 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18723 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018724
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018725ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18726 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18727 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018728 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018729
18730ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18731 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18732 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018733 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018734
18735ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18736 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18737 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18738 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018739 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018740 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018741
18742ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18743 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18744 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018745 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018746
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018747ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18748 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18749 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18750 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18751
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018752ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18753 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18754 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18755 transport layer.
18756 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18757 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18758 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18759 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18760
18761ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18762 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18763 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18764 transport layer.
18765 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18766 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18767 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18768 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18769
18770ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18771 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18772 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18773 transport layer.
18774 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18775 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18776 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18777 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18778
18779ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18780 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18781 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18782 transport layer.
18783 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18784 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18785 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18786 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18787
18788ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18789 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18790 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18791 transport layer.
18792 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18793 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18794 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18795 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018797ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018798 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18799 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018800 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18801 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18802 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18803 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018804
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018805ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18806 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18807 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18808 wait until the handshake happened.
18809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018810ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18811 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018812 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18813 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018814 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018815 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018816
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018817ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018818 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018819 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18820 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018822ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018823 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018824 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018825 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18826 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18827 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18828 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18829 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18830 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018832ssl_fc_protocol : string
18833 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18834 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018835
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018836ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018837 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018838 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018839 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018840
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018841ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18842 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18843 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18844 transport layer.
18845 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18846 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18847 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18848 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18849
18850ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18851 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18852 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18853 transport layer.
18854 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18855 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18856 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18857 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18858
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018859ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18860 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18861 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18862 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018864ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18865 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18866 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18867 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18868 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018869
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018870ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18871 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18872 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18873 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18874 BoringSSL.
18875
18876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018877ssl_fc_sni : string
18878 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18879 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018880 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018881 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18882 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18883
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018884 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018885 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018886 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018887 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018888 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018889
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010018890 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
18891 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
18892 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
18893 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
18894 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
18895 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
18896 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
18897 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
18898 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
18899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018900 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018901 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18902 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018904ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18905 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18906 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018907
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018908ssl_s_der : binary
18909 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18910 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18911 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18912
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018913ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18914 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18915 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18916 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018917 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018918 does not support resumed sessions.
18919
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018920ssl_s_key_alg : string
18921 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18922 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18923 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18924
18925ssl_s_notafter : string
18926 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18927 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18928 transport layer.
18929
18930ssl_s_notbefore : string
18931 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18932 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18933 transport layer.
18934
18935ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18936 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18937 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18938 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18939 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18940 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18941 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018942 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18943 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018944 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18945 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18946 LDAP v3.
18947 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18948 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18949
18950ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18951 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18952 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18953 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18954 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18955 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18956 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018957 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18958 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018959 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18960 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18961 LDAP v3.
18962 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18963 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18964
18965ssl_s_serial : binary
18966 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18967 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18968 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18969
18970ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18971 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18972 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18973 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18974
18975ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18976 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18977 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18978 layer.
18979
18980ssl_s_version : integer
18981 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18982 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018983
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189847.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018985------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018987Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18988sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18989only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18990For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18991be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18992can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18993sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18994for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18995content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018996
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018997Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18998 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018999 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019000 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19001 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19002 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19003 sample expression). So be careful.
19004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019005payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019006 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019007 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19008 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019010payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19011 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019012 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019013 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019015req.len : integer
19016req_len : integer (deprecated)
19017 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19018 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19019 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19020 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19021 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019022 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019023 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19024 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019026req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19027 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019028 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19029 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19030 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19031 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019032
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019033 ACL derivatives :
19034 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019036req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19037 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19038 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19039 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19040 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019041
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019042 ACL derivatives :
19043 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019045 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019047req.proto_http : boolean
19048req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19049 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19050 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19051 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19052 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19053 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19054 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19055 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019057 Example:
19058 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19059 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19060 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019061 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019063req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19064rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19065 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19066 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19067 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19068 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19069 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19070 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19071 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019073 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19074 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19075 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19076 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19077 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19078 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019080 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019081 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019083 Example :
19084 listen tse-farm
19085 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19086 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19087 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19088 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19089 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19090 persist rdp-cookie
19091 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19092 # This is only useful makes sense if
19093 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19094 stick-table type string size 204800
19095 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19096 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19097 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019099 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019100 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019102req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19103rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19104 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19105 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19106 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19107 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019109 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019110 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019111
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019112req.ssl_alpn : string
19113 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19114 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19115 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19116 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19117 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19118 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019119 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019120
19121 Examples :
19122 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19123 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019124 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019125 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019126 default_backend bk_default
19127
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019128req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19129 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19130 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019131 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19132 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19133 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19134 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19135 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019137req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19138req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19139 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19140 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19141 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19142 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19143 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19144 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19145 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019147req.ssl_sni : string
19148req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19149 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19150 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19151 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19152 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19153 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019154 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19155 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19156 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19157 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19158 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19159 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19160 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19161 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19162 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019164 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019165 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019167 Examples :
19168 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19169 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019170 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019171 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019172 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019173
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019174req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19175 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19176 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19177 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19178 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19179 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19180 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19181 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19182 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19183 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019185req.ssl_ver : integer
19186req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19187 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19188 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19189 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19190 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19191 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19192 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19193 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019194 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019195 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019197 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019198 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019199
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019200res.len : integer
19201 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19202 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19203 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19204 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19205 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019206 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019207 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019208 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019210res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19211 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019212 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019213 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019214 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019215 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019217res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19218 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19219 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19220 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019221 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19222 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019224 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019225
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019226res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19227rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19228 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19229 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19230 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19231 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19232 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19233 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19234 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019236wait_end : boolean
19237 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19238 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019239 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019240 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19241 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019242 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019243 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19244 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019246 Examples :
19247 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19248 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19249 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019251 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19252 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19253 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19254 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19255 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19256 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19257 tcp-request content reject
19258
19259
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192607.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019261--------------------------------------
19262
19263It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19264This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19265data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19266its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19267HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19268content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19269to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19270more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19271response are indexed.
19272
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019273Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19274 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19275 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19276 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19277 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19278 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19279 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019281base : string
19282 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19283 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19284 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19285 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19286 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19287 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19288 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19289 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19290
19291 ACL derivatives :
19292 base : exact string match
19293 base_beg : prefix match
19294 base_dir : subdir match
19295 base_dom : domain match
19296 base_end : suffix match
19297 base_len : length match
19298 base_reg : regex match
19299 base_sub : substring match
19300
19301base32 : integer
19302 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19303 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19304 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019305 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19306 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19307 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019308
19309base32+src : binary
19310 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19311 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19312 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19313 per-URL counters.
19314
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019315baseq : string
19316 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19317 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19318 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19319 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19320
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019321capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19322 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19323 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19324 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19325
19326capture.req.method : string
19327 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19328 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19329 because it's allocated.
19330
19331capture.req.uri : string
19332 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19333 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19334 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19335 allocated.
19336
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019337capture.req.ver : string
19338 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19339 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19340 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19341
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019342capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19343 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19344 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19345 The first entry is an index of 0.
19346 See also: "capture response header"
19347
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019348capture.res.ver : string
19349 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19350 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19351 persistent flag.
19352
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019353req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019354 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19355 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19356 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019357
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019358req.body_param([<name>) : string
19359 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19360 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19361 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19362 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19363 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19364 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19365 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19366 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19367 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19368 given.
19369
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019370req.body_len : integer
19371 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19372 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019373 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19374 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019375
19376req.body_size : integer
19377 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019378 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19379 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019381req.cook([<name>]) : string
19382cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19383 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19384 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19385 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19386 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19387 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19388 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19389 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19390 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19391
19392 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019393 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19394 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19395 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19396 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19397 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19398 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19399 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19400 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019402req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19403cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19404 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19405 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019407req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19408cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19409 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19410 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19411 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19412 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019414cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19415 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19416 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19417 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19418 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019419 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019420 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19421 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19422 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19423 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019425hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19426 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19427 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19428 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19429 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019430 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019432req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019433 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19434 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19435 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19436 with headers such as User-Agent.
19437
19438 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19439 found.
19440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019441 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19442 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19443 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019444 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019446req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19447 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19448 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019449 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19450 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019452req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019453 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19454 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19455 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19456 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19457 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19458 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19459 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19460
19461 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19462 found.
19463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019464 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19465 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19466 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019467 with -1 being the last one.
19468
19469 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19470 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019472 ACL derivatives :
19473 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19474 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19475 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19476 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19477 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19478 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19479 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19480 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19481
19482req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19483hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19484 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19485 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019486 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19487 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19488 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19489
19490 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19491 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19492 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19493
19494 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019495
19496req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19497hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19498 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19499 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19500 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019501 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19502 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19503 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19504 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19505 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019506
19507 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19508
19509 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019510
19511req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19512hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19513 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19514 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19515 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019516
19517 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19518
19519 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019520
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019521req.hdrs : string
19522 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19523 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19524 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19525 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19526
19527req.hdrs_bin : binary
19528 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19529 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19530 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19531 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19532 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19533 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19534
19535 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019536
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019537 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19538 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019540http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19541 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19542 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19543 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19544 basic auth is supported.
19545
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019546http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19547 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19548 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19549 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19550 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019551 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19552 basic auth is supported.
19553
19554 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019555 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19556 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19557 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19558 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019559
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019560http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019561 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19562 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19563 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019564
19565http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019566 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19567 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19568 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019569
19570http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019571 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19572 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19573 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019575http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019576 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19577 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019578 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19579 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019581method : integer + string
19582 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19583 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19584 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19585 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19586 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19587 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19588 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019590 ACL derivatives :
19591 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019593 Example :
19594 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19595 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19596 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019598path : string
19599 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19600 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19601 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19602 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19603 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019604 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019605 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019607 ACL derivatives :
19608 path : exact string match
19609 path_beg : prefix match
19610 path_dir : subdir match
19611 path_dom : domain match
19612 path_end : suffix match
19613 path_len : length match
19614 path_reg : regex match
19615 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019616
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019617pathq : string
19618 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19619 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19620 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19621 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19622 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19623 result in both cases.
19624
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019625query : string
19626 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19627 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19628 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19629 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019630 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019631 which stops before the question mark.
19632
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019633req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19634 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19635 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19636 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19637 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019639req.ver : string
19640req_ver : string (deprecated)
19641 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19642 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19643 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019645 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019646 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019647
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019648res.body : binary
19649 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19650 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019651 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19652
19653 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019654
19655res.body_len : integer
19656 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19657 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019658 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19659
19660 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019661
19662res.body_size : integer
19663 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19664 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19665 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19666 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019667 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19668
19669 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019670
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019671res.cache_hit : boolean
19672 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19673 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19674
19675res.cache_name : string
19676 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19677 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19678 empty string.
19679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019680res.comp : boolean
19681 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19682 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19683 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019685res.comp_algo : string
19686 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19687 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19688 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019690res.cook([<name>]) : string
19691scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19692 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19693 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019694 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19695
19696 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019698 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019699 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019701res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19702scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19703 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19704 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019705 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19706
19707 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019709res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19710scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19711 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19712 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019713 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19714
19715 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019717res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019718 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19719 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19720
19721 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19722 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19723
19724 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19725
19726 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019728res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019729 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19730 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19731
19732 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19733 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19734
19735 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019737res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19738shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019739 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19740 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19741
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019742 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019743 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19744
19745 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019747 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019748 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19749 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19750 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19751 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19752 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19753 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19754 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19755 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019756
19757res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19758shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019759 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19760 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19761
19762 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019763 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019764
19765 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019767res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19768shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019769 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19770 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19771
19772 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19773
19774 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019775
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019776res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19777 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19778 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19779 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019780 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19781
19782 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019784res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19785shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019786 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19787 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19788
19789 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19790
19791 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019792
19793res.hdrs : string
19794 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19795 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19796 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019797 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19798
19799 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019800
19801res.hdrs_bin : binary
19802 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19803 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19804 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19805 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19806 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19807 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19808 (length of 0 for both).
19809
19810 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19811
19812 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19813 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019815res.ver : string
19816resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19817 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019818 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19819
19820 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019822 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019823 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019825set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19826 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19827 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019828 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019829 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019831 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19832 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019834status : integer
19835 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19836 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019837 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19838
19839 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019840
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019841unique-id : string
19842 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19843 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19844 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19845 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19846 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19847 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019849url : string
19850 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19851 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19852 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19853 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19854 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19855 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19856 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019858 ACL derivatives :
19859 url : exact string match
19860 url_beg : prefix match
19861 url_dir : subdir match
19862 url_dom : domain match
19863 url_end : suffix match
19864 url_len : length match
19865 url_reg : regex match
19866 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019868url_ip : ip
19869 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19870 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19871 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19872 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19873 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19874 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19875 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019877url_port : integer
19878 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19879 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19880 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19881 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019882
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019883urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19884url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019885 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19886 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019887 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19888 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19889 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19890 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019891 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19892 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019893 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19894 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019896 ACL derivatives :
19897 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19898 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19899 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19900 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19901 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19902 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19903 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19904 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019905
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019907 Example :
19908 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19909 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19910 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19911 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019912
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019913urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019914 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19915 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19916 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019917
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019918url32 : integer
19919 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19920 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19921 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19922 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19923 is an unsigned integer.
19924
19925url32+src : binary
19926 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19927 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19928 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19929
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019930
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200199317.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019932---------------------------------------
19933
19934This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19935used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19936purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19937There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19938or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19939any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19940for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19941
19942internal.htx.data : integer
19943 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19944 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19945
19946internal.htx.free : integer
19947 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19948 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19949
19950internal.htx.free_data : integer
19951 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19952 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19953
19954internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019955 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19956 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19957 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019958
19959internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19960 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19961 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19962
19963internal.htx.size : integer
19964 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19965 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19966
19967internal.htx.used : integer
19968 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19969 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19970 direction.
19971
19972internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19973 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19974 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19975 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19976 of the special value :
19977 * head : The oldest inserted block
19978 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019979 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019980
19981internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19982 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19983 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19984 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19985 integer or one of the special value :
19986 * head : The oldest inserted block
19987 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019988 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019989
19990internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19991 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19992 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19993 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19994 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19995
19996 * head : The oldest inserted block
19997 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019998 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019999
20000internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20001 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20002 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20003 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20004 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20005
20006 * head : The oldest inserted block
20007 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020008 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020009
20010internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20011 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20012 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20013 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20014 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20015
20016 * head : The oldest inserted block
20017 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020018 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020019
20020internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20021 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20022 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20023 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20024 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20025
20026 * head : The oldest inserted block
20027 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020028 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020029
20030internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20031 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20032 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20033 it returns false.
20034
20035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200200367.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020037---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020039Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20040every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020041order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020043ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020044---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20045FALSE always_false never match
20046HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20047HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20048HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020049HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020050HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20051HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20052HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20053HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20054LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20055METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20056METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20057METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20058METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20059METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20060METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20061METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20062METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20063RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20064REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20065TRUE always_true always match
20066WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20067---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020068
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200708. Logging
20071----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020072
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020073One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20074provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20075very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20076provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20077state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020078to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020079headers.
20080
20081In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20082about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20083send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20084
20085 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20086 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20087 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20088 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20089 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020090 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020091 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020092
20093The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20094allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20095as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20096while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20097real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20098delay.
20099
20100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201018.1. Log levels
20102---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020103
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020104TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020105source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020106HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20107in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20108track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20109syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20110about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020111
20112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201138.2. Log formats
20114----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020115
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020116HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020117and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20118slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20119options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020120
20121 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20122 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20123 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20124 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20125 extents.
20126
20127 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20128 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20129 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20130 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20131 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20132
20133 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20134 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20135 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20136 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20137 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20138
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020139 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20140 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20141 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20142 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20143
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020144 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20145
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020146Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20147specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20148field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20149servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20150always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20151identifier.
20152
20153Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20154 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20155 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20156 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20157 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20158
20159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201608.2.1. Default log format
20161-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020162
20163This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20164as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20165format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20166
20167 Example :
20168 listen www
20169 mode http
20170 log global
20171 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20172
20173 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20174 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20175 (www/HTTP)
20176
20177 Field Format Extract from the example above
20178 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20179 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20180 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20181 4 'to' to
20182 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20183 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20184
20185Detailed fields description :
20186 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20187 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20188 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20189 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20190 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20191 and processed the connection.
20192 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20193
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020194In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20195"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20196connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20197
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020198It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20199will eventually disappear.
20200
20201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202028.2.2. TCP log format
20203---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020204
20205The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20206is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20207information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20208counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20209emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20210environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20211the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20212sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020213specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20214not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20215fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20216marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020217
20218 Example :
20219 frontend fnt
20220 mode tcp
20221 option tcplog
20222 log global
20223 default_backend bck
20224
20225 backend bck
20226 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20227
20228 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20229 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20230 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20231
20232 Field Format Extract from the example above
20233 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20234 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20235 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20236 4 frontend_name fnt
20237 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20238 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20239 7 bytes_read* 212
20240 8 termination_state --
20241 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20242 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20243
20244Detailed fields description :
20245 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020246 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020247 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20248 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020249 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020250 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020251 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020252
20253 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020254 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20255 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20256 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020257
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020258 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020259 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20260 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020261 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20262 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20263 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20264 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020265
20266 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20267 and processed the connection.
20268
20269 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20270 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20271 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20272 applications.
20273
20274 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20275 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20276 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20277 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20278 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20279
20280 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20281 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20282 See "Timers" below for more details.
20283
20284 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20285 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20286 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20287 "Timers" below for more details.
20288
20289 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020290 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020291 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20292 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20293 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20294 details.
20295
20296 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20297 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20298 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20299 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20300 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20301
20302 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20303 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20304 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20305 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20306 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20307 for more details.
20308
20309 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020310 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020311 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20312 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20313 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020314 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020315
20316 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20317 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20318 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20319 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20320 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20321 caused by a denial of service attack.
20322
20323 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20324 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20325 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20326 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20327 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20328 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20329 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20330 denial of service attack.
20331
20332 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20333 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20334 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20335 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20336 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20337 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20338 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20339 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20340 be processed than on other servers.
20341
20342 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20343 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20344 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20345 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020346 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020347 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20348 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20349 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20350 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20351 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20352 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20353 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20354 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20355
20356 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20357 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20358 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20359 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20360 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20361 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020362 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020363 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20364
20365 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20366 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20367 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20368 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20369 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20370 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020371 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020372 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20373 occurs.
20374
20375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203768.2.3. HTTP log format
20377----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020378
20379The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20380is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20381the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20382are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20383emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20384generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20385"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20386which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020387frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20388is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020389
20390Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20391slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20392with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20393
20394 Example :
20395 frontend http-in
20396 mode http
20397 option httplog
20398 log global
20399 default_backend bck
20400
20401 backend static
20402 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20403
20404 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20405 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20406 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020407 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020408
20409 Field Format Extract from the example above
20410 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20411 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020412 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020413 4 frontend_name http-in
20414 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020415 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020416 7 status_code 200
20417 8 bytes_read* 2750
20418 9 captured_request_cookie -
20419 10 captured_response_cookie -
20420 11 termination_state ----
20421 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20422 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20423 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20424 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20425 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020426
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020427Detailed fields description :
20428 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020429 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020430 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20431 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020432 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020433 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020434 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020435
20436 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020437 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20438 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20439 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020440
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020441 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020442 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020443
20444 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20445 and processed the connection.
20446
20447 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20448 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20449 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20450
20451 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20452 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20453 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20454 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20455 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20456 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20457
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020458 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20459 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20460 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020461 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020462 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20463 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020464 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020465 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020466
20467 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20468 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020469 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020470
20471 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20472 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020473 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20474 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020475
20476 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20477 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20478 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20479 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20480 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020481 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20482 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020483
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020484 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020485 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20486 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20487 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20488 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20489 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20490 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020491 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020492
20493 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020494 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20495 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020496
20497 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20498 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020499 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020500 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20501 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20502 overflowing.
20503
20504 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20505 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20506 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20507 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20508 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20509 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20510 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20511 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20512
20513 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20514 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20515 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20516 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20517 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20518 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20519 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20520 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20521
20522 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20523 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20524 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20525 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20526 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20527 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20528 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20529
20530 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020531 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020532 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20533 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20534 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020535 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020536 system.
20537
20538 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20539 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20540 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20541 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20542 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20543 caused by a denial of service attack.
20544
20545 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20546 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20547 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20548 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20549 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20550 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20551 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20552 denial of service attack.
20553
20554 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20555 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20556 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20557 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20558 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20559 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20560 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20561 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20562 processed than on other servers.
20563
20564 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20565 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20566 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20567 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020568 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020569 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20570 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20571 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20572 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20573 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20574 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20575 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20576 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20577
20578 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20579 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20580 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20581 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20582 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20583 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020584 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020585 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20586
20587 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20588 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20589 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20590 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20591 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20592 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020593 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020594 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20595 occurs.
20596
20597 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20598 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20599 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20600 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20601 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20602 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20603 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20604 cookies" below for more details.
20605
20606 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20607 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20608 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20609 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20610 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20611 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20612 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20613 and cookies" below for more details.
20614
20615 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20616 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20617 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20618 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20619 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20620 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20621 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20622 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20623
20624
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200206258.2.4. Custom log format
20626------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020627
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020628The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020629mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020630
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020631HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020632Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20633separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20634prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20635
20636Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20637variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020638("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020639
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020640If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020641as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020642less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20643the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20644
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020645Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20646"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20647delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20648preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020649
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020650Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20651'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20652https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20653such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20654
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020655Flags are :
20656 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020657 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020658 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20659 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020660
20661 Example:
20662
20663 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20664 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20665
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020666 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20667
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020668At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20669
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020670 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20671 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020672
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020673the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020674
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020675 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20676 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20677 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020678
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020679and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20680
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020681 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20682 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020683
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020684Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20685
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020686 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020687 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020688 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20689 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20690 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020691 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20692 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20693 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020694 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020695 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020696 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020697 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020698 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020699 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20700 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020701 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020702 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020703 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020704 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020705 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020706 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020707 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020708 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20709 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20710 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20711 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20712 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020713 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020714 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020715 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020716 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020717 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020718 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20719 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020720 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20721 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20722 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020723 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020724 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20725 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020726 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020727 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20728 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20729 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020730 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020731 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020732 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20733 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20734 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20735 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020736 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020737 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020738 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020739 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020740 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020741 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020742 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20743 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20744 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020745 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020746 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20747 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020748 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020749 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20750 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020751 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020752 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020753 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020754 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020755
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020756 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020757
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020758
207598.2.5. Error log format
20760-----------------------
20761
20762When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020763protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020764By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20765"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020766will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020767logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20768
20769The format looks like this :
20770
20771 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20772 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20773 Connection error during SSL handshake
20774
20775 Field Format Extract from the example above
20776 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20777 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20778 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20779 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20780 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20781
20782These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20783failures.
20784
20785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207868.3. Advanced logging options
20787-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020788
20789Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20790just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20791options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20792for more information about their usage.
20793
20794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20796------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020797
20798It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020799HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020800commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20801monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20802ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20803
20804 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20805 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20806 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20807 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20808
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020809 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20810 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020811
20812 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20813 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20814 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20815
20816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208178.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20818----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020819
20820The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20821what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20822or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020823"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020824just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20825log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20826after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20827is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20828with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20829with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20830
20831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208328.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20833------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020834
20835Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20836for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20837"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20838retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20839raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20840a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20841file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20842you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20843"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20844
20845
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208468.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20847--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020848
20849Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20850multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20851them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20852"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20853logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20854error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20855and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20856too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20857useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20858alternative.
20859
20860
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208618.4. Timing events
20862------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020863
20864Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20865reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20866the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20867frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020868mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20869addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20870
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020871Timings events in HTTP mode:
20872
20873 first request 2nd request
20874 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20875 t tr t tr ...
20876 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20877 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20878 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20879 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020880 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020881 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20882
20883Timings events in TCP mode:
20884
20885 TCP session
20886 |<----------------->|
20887 t t
20888 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20889 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20890 |<------ Tt ------->|
20891
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020892 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020893 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020894 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20895 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20896 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020897 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020898 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20899 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20900 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20901 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020902
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020903 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20904 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20905 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020906 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20907 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20908 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20909 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20910 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20911 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020912
20913 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20914 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20915 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20916 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20917 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20918 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20919 request typed by hand during a test.
20920
20921 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20922 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020923 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020924 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20925 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20926 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20927 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020928
20929 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20930 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20931 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20932 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20933 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20934
20935 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20936 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20937 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20938 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20939 connection never established.
20940
20941 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20942 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20943 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20944 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20945 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20946 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20947 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20948 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20949 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20950 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20951 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20952
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020953 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20954 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20955 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20956 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20957 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20958 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20959
20960 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20961
20962 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20963 "Ta" can never be negative.
20964
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020965 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20966 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020967 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20968 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020969 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020970
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020971 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020972
20973 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020974 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20975 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020976
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020977 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20978 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20979 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20980 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20981 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20982 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20983 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20984 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20985
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020986These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20987protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20988that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020989due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20990"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20991that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020992
20993Most common cases :
20994
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020995 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20996 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20997 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20998 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20999 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021000 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021001 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21002 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21003 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21004 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21005 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021006 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021007
21008 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21009 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21010 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21011 of ms on remote networks.
21012
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021013 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21014 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21015 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021016
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021017 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21018 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021019 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021020 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21021 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21022 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21023 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21024 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21025 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021026
21027Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21028
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021029 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021030 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021031 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021032
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021033 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021034 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21035 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21036
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021037 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021038 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21039 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21040 flags.
21041
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021042 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21043 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021044 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21045 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21046 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21047 the client connection was maintained open.
21048
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021049 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021050 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021051 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021052 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21053
21054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210558.5. Session state at disconnection
21056-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021057
21058TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21059"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
210602-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21061each of which has a special meaning :
21062
21063 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21064 session to terminate :
21065
21066 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21067
21068 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21069 server explicitly refused it.
21070
21071 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21072 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21073 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21074 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021075 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021076
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021077 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021078 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021079
21080 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21081 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21082 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21083 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21084 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21085
21086 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21087 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21088 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21089 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21090 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21091
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021092 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021093 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21094
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021095 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021096 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21097 backup connections when going up.
21098
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021099 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021100
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021101 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21102 send or receive data.
21103
21104 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21105 send or receive data.
21106
21107 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21108 with nothing left in the buffers.
21109
21110 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21111
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021112 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021113 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21114
21115 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21116 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21117 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21118 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21119 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21120
21121 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21122 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21123
21124 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21125 server (HTTP only).
21126
21127 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21128
21129 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21130 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21131 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21132
21133 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21134 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21135 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21136
21137 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21138
21139 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21140 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21141
21142 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21143 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21144 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21145
21146 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21147 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021148 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21149 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021150
21151 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21152 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21153 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21154 another server.
21155
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021156 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021157 server.
21158
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021159 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21160 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21161 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21162 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21163
21164 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21165 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21166 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21167 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21168
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021169 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21170 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21171 "use-server" rule).
21172
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021173 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21174
21175 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21176 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21177
21178 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21179
21180 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21181 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21182 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21183
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021184 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21185 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021186 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021187 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21188 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21189
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021190 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21191
21192 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21193 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21194
21195 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21196
21197 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21198
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021199The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21200was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021201helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21202starvation, attacks, etc...
21203
21204The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21205alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21206easier finding and understanding.
21207
21208 Flags Reason
21209
21210 -- Normal termination.
21211
21212 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021213 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21214 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021215 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21216
21217 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21218 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021219 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21220 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021221 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21222 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021223
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021224 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21225 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021226 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021227
21228 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21229 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21230 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21231
21232 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21233 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21234 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21235 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21236 the server takes too long to respond.
21237
21238 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21239 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21240 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21241 long a time to respond.
21242
21243 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21244 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21245 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021246 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021247 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21248 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021249
21250 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21251 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21252 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21253 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21254 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021255 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021256 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21257 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21258 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21259 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21260 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21261 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21262 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21263 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021264 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021265 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21266 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21267 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021268
21269 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21270 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021271 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21272 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21273 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21274 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021275
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021276 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021277 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21278
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021279 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021280 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21281 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021282 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021283 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21284 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21285
21286 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21287 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21288 503 or 504 here.
21289
21290 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021291 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021292 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21293 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21294 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21295
21296 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21297 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021298 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021299 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021300 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021301
21302 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21303 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21304 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21305 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21306 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21307 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021308 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021309
21310 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21311 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21312 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21313 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21314 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21315 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21316 solution is to fix the application.
21317
21318 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21319 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21320 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21321 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21322 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21323 external attacks.
21324
21325 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021326 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021327 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021328 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21329 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21330
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021331 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21332 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21333 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021334 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021335 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021336
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021337 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21338 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21339 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21340 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021341 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21342 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21343 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21344 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021345 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21346 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21347 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21348 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021349
21350 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21351 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21352 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021353 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21354 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21355 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21356 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021357
21358 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21359 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21360 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21361 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21362
21363 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21364 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21365 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21366 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21367
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021368The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021369persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021370important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21371re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21372
21373 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21374
21375 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21376 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21377 set on a GET request.
21378
21379 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21380 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021381 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021382 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21383
21384 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21385 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21386 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21387
21388 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21389 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21390 already got a cookie.
21391
21392 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21393 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21394 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21395 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21396 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21397
21398 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21399 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21400 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21401
21402 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21403 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21404 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21405
21406 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21407 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21408
21409 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21410 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21411 then advertised in the response.
21412
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214148.6. Non-printable characters
21415-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021416
21417In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21418consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21419converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21420prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21421being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21422escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21423is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21424'}' when logging headers.
21425
21426Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21427issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21428containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21429
21430Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21431the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21432performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21433
21434
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214358.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21436---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021437
21438Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21439achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021440section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021441cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21442the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21443the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021444locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021445not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21446user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21447a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21448wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21449
21450 Examples :
21451 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21452 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21453
21454 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21455 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21456
21457
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214588.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21459---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021460
21461Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21462proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21463the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21464server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21465
21466Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21467response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021468section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021469
21470It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021471time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21472appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021473are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21474and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21475follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21476request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21477in the logs.
21478
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021479As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21480frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21481an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21482
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021483 Example :
21484 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21485 listen proxy-out
21486 mode http
21487 option httplog
21488 option logasap
21489 log global
21490 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21491
21492 # log the name of the virtual server
21493 capture request header Host len 20
21494
21495 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21496 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21497
21498 # log the beginning of the referrer
21499 capture request header Referer len 20
21500
21501 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21502 capture response header Server len 20
21503
21504 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21505 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21506
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021507 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021508 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21509
21510 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21511 capture response header Via len 20
21512
21513 # log the URL location during a redirection
21514 capture response header Location len 20
21515
21516 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21517 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21518 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21519 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21520 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21521
21522 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21523 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21524 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21525 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021526 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021527
21528 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21529 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21530 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21531 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21532 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021533 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021534
21535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215368.9. Examples of logs
21537---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021538
21539These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21540them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21541reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21542
21543 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21544 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21545 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21546
21547 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21548 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21549
21550 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21551 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21552 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21553
21554 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21555 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21556
21557 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21558 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21559 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21560
21561 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021562 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021563 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21564 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21565
21566 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21567 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21568 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21569
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021570 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21571 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21572 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21573 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021574 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021575 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021576
21577 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021578 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021579
21580 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21581 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21582 Nothing was sent to any server.
21583
21584 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21585 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21586
21587 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21588 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021589 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021590 send a 408 return code to the client.
21591
21592 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21593 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21594
21595 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21596 5 seconds ("c----").
21597
21598 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21599 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021600 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021601
21602 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021603 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021604 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21605 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21606 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21607 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21608 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021609
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021610
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200216119. Supported filters
21612--------------------
21613
21614Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21615accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21616unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21617
21618See also : "filter"
21619
216209.1. Trace
21621----------
21622
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021623filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021624
21625 Arguments:
21626 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21627 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21628
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021629 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021630
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021631 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021632 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21633 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21634 amount of the parsed data.
21635
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021636 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021637
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021638This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21639callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21640information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21641filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21642
21643Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21644tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21645a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21646
21647
216489.2. HTTP compression
21649---------------------
21650
21651filter compression
21652
21653The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21654keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021655when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21656fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21657done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21658explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21659filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21660listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21661order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021662
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021663See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21664 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021665
21666
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200216679.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21668--------------------------------------------
21669
21670filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21671
21672 Arguments :
21673
21674 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21675 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21676 parsed.
21677
21678 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21679 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21680 part must be placed in its own scope.
21681
21682The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21683external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021684streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021685exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21686also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21687
21688SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21689the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21690
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021691For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021692"doc/SPOE.txt".
21693
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100216949.4. Cache
21695----------
21696
21697filter cache <name>
21698
21699 Arguments :
21700
21701 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21702
21703The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21704"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021705cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021706other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21707case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21708is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21709filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021710listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21711order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021712
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021713See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21714 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21715
21716
217179.5. Fcgi-app
21718-------------
21719
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021720filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021721
21722 Arguments :
21723
21724 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21725
21726The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21727request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21728reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21729used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21730implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21731used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21732fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21733used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21734order.
21735
21736See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21737 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21738
21739
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100217409.6. OpenTracing
21741----------------
21742
21743The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21744HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21745of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21746Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21747
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021748This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021749
21750The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21751HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21752participates in the work of HAProxy.
21753
21754filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21755
21756 Arguments :
21757
21758 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21759 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21760 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21761 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21762 OpenTracing filters.
21763
21764 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21765 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21766 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21767 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21768 filter must have its own scope defined.
21769
21770More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021771of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021772
21773
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002177410. FastCGI applications
21775-------------------------
21776
21777HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21778feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21779the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21780FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21781servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21782FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21783backend.
21784
21785HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21786application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21787connection.
21788
2178910.1. Setup
21790-----------
21791
2179210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21793--------------------------
21794
21795fcgi-app <name>
21796 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21797 document root must be defined.
21798
21799acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21800 Declare or complete an access list.
21801
21802 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21803 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21804 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21805 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21806 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21807
21808docroot <path>
21809 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21810 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21811 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21812
21813index <script-name>
21814 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21815 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21816 is an optional setting.
21817
21818 Example :
21819 index index.php
21820
21821log-stderr global
21822log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021823 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021824 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21825
21826 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21827 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21828
21829pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21830 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21831 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21832 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21833
21834 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21835 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21836 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21837 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21838
21839 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21840 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21841
21842path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021843 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021844 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21845 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21846 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21847 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21848 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21849 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21850 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021851
21852 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021853 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021854 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21855 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21856 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21857 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021858
21859 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021860 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21861 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021862
21863option get-values
21864no option get-values
21865 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21866
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021867 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021868 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21869
21870 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21871 application will accept.
21872
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021873 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21874 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021875
21876 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021877 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021878 option is disabled.
21879
21880 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21881 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21882 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21883 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21884 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21885 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21886
21887option keep-conn
21888no option keep-conn
21889 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21890 sending a response.
21891
21892 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21893 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21894
21895option max-reqs <reqs>
21896 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21897 accept.
21898
21899 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21900 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21901 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21902 to 1.
21903
21904option mpxs-conns
21905no option mpxs-conns
21906 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21907
21908 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21909 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21910
21911set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21912 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21913 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21914 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21915 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21916
21917 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21918 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21919 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21920
21921 Example :
21922 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21923 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21924
21925 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21926
21927
2192810.1.2. Proxy section
21929---------------------
21930
21931use-fcgi-app <name>
21932 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21933
21934 Arguments :
21935 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21936
21937 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21938 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21939 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21940 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21941 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21942
21943 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21944 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21945 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21946 application are evaluated.
21947
21948
2194910.1.3. Example
21950---------------
21951
21952 frontend front-http
21953 mode http
21954 bind *:80
21955 bind *:
21956
21957 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21958 default_backend back-static
21959
21960 backend back-static
21961 mode http
21962 server www A.B.C.D:80
21963
21964 backend back-dynamic
21965 mode http
21966 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21967 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21968
21969 fcgi-app php-fpm
21970 log-stderr global
21971 option keep-conn
21972
21973 docroot /var/www/my-app
21974 index index.php
21975 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21976
21977
2197810.2. Default parameters
21979------------------------
21980
21981A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21982the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021983script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021984applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21985
21986 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21987 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21988 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21989 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21990 | | |
21991 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21992 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21993 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21994 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21995 | | application. |
21996 | | |
21997 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21998 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21999 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22000 | | |
22001 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22002 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22003 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22004 | | the application's configuration. |
22005 | | |
22006 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22007 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22008 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22009 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22010 | | |
22011 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22012 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22013 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22014 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22015 | | be defined. |
22016 | | |
22017 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22018 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22019 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22020 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22021 | | is not set too. |
22022 | | |
22023 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22024 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22025 | | set. |
22026 | | |
22027 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22028 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22029 | | the request. |
22030 | | |
22031 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22032 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22033 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22034 | | |
22035 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22036 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22037 | | script to process the request. |
22038 | | |
22039 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22040 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22041 | | |
22042 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22043 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22044 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22045 | | |
22046 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22047 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22048 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22049 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22050 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22051 | | |
22052 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22053 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22054 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22055 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22056 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22057 | | side. |
22058 | | |
22059 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22060 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22061 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22062 | | connected to. |
22063 | | |
22064 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22065 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22066 | | |
22067 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022068 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22069 | | current HAProxy version. |
22070 | | |
22071 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022072 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22073 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22074 | | |
22075 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22076
22077
2207810.3. Limitations
22079------------------
22080
22081The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22082way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22083during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22084establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22085application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22086or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22087message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22088these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22089and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22090
22091Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22092request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22093requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22094
22095About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22096into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22097fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22098"http-request" ones.
22099
22100Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22101FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22102processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22103must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22104here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022105
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022106
2210711. Address formats
22108-------------------
22109
22110Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22111address.
22112
22113This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22114The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22115of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22116equivalent is '::'.
22117
22118Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22119is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22120
22121This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22122family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22123
22124Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22125configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22126use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22127'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22128
22129Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22130socket type and the transport method.
22131
22132
2213311.1 Address family prefixes
22134----------------------------
22135
22136'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22137
22138'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22139 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22140 listening.
22141
22142'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22143 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22144 on the statement using this address, a port or
22145 a port range may or must be specified.
22146
22147'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22148 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22149 using this address, a port or a port range
22150 may or must be specified.
22151
22152'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22153 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22154 using this address, a port or a port range
22155 may or must be specified.
22156
22157'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22158 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22159 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22160 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22161 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22162 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22163
22164'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22165 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22166 start by slash '/'.
22167
22168
2216911.2 Socket type prefixes
22170-------------------------
22171
22172Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22173type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22174this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22175This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22176but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22177
22178Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22179instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22180
22181If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22182they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22183report this to the maintainers.
22184
22185'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22186 to "stream"
22187
22188'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22189 to "datagram".
22190
22191
2219211.3 Protocol prefixes
22193----------------------
22194
22195'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22196 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22197 socket type and transport method is forced to
22198 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22199 this address, a port or a port range can or
22200 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22201 of 'stream+ip@'.
22202
22203'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22204 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22205 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22206 statement using this address, a port or port
22207 range can or must be specified.
22208 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22209
22210'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22211 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22212 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22213 statement using this address, a port or port
22214 range can or must be specified.
22215 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22216
22217'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22218 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22219 socket type and transport method is forced to
22220 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22221 this address, a port or a port range can or
22222 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22223 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22224
22225'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22226 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22227 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22228 the statement using this address, a port or
22229 port range can or must be specified.
22230 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22231
22232'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22233 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22234 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22235 the statement using this address, a port or
22236 port range can or must be specified.
22237 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22238
22239'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22240 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22241 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22242
22243'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22244 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22245 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22246
22247In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22248QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22249
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022250/*
22251 * Local variables:
22252 * fill-column: 79
22253 * End:
22254 */